User Manual
User Manual
User Manual
This manual is for GNU PSPP version 0.7.9-gb6493c, software for statistical analysis. Copyright c 1997, 1998, 2004, 2005, 2009, 2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License".
The authors wish to thank Network Theory Ltd http://www.network-theory.co.uk for their financial support in the production of this manual.
Table of Contents
1 2 3 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Your rights and obligations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Invoking pspp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 Main Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 PDF, PostScript, and SVG Output Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Plain Text Output Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 HTML Output Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 OpenDocument Output Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Comma-Separated Value Output Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
4 5
Invoking psppire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
4.1 The graphic user interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Using pspp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
5.1 Preparation of Data Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.1 Defining Variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.2 Listing the data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.3 Reading data from a text file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.4 Reading data from a pre-prepared pspp file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.5 Saving data to a pspp file. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.6 Reading data from other sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 Data Screening and Transformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.1 Identifying incorrect data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.2 Dealing with suspicious data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.3 Inverting negatively coded variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.4 Testing data consistency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.5 Testing for normality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 Hypothesis Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3.1 Testing for differences of means . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3.2 Linear Regression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 13 13 14 14 14 15 15 15 16 17 17 18 21 21 22
ii 6.7.1 Attributes of Variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.2 Variables Automatically Defined by pspp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.3 Lists of variable names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4 Input and Output Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4.1 Basic Numeric Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4.2 Custom Currency Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4.3 Legacy Numeric Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4.4 Binary and Hexadecimal Numeric Formats . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4.5 Time and Date Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4.6 Date Component Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.4.7 String Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.5 Scratch Variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.8 Files Used by pspp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.9 File Handles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.10 Backus-Naur Form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 32 32 32 33 35 36 37 38 41 41 41 41 42 43
Mathematical Expressions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 Boolean Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Missing Values in Expressions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grouping Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Arithmetic Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Logical Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Relational Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.1 Mathematical Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.2 Miscellaneous Mathematical Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.3 Trigonometric Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.4 Missing-Value Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.5 Set-Membership Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.6 Statistical Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.7 String Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.8 Time & Date Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.8.1 How times & dates are defined and represented . . . . . . 7.7.8.2 Functions that Produce Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.8.3 Functions that Examine Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.8.4 Functions that Produce Dates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.8.5 Functions that Examine Dates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.8.6 Time and Date Arithmetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.9 Miscellaneous Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.10 Statistical Distribution Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.10.1 Continuous Distributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7.10.2 Discrete Distributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.8 Operator Precedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 44 44 44 45 45 46 46 46 47 47 48 48 49 51 51 51 51 52 53 54 55 55 56 60 61
iii
10
iv
11
Manipulating variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
ADD VALUE LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 DELETE VARIABLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 FORMATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 LEAVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 MISSING VALUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 MODIFY VARS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 MRSETS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 NUMERIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 PRINT FORMATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 RENAME VARIABLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 VALUE LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 STRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 VARIABLE ATTRIBUTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 VARIABLE LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 VARIABLE ALIGNMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 VARIABLE WIDTH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 VARIABLE LEVEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 VECTOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 WRITE FORMATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 11.5 11.6 11.7 11.8 11.9 11.10 11.11 11.12 11.13 11.14 11.15 11.16 11.17 11.18 11.19 11.20
12
13
14
15
Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
123 124 125 128 128 131 133 134 136 136 137 137 137 137 138 138 138 139 139 139 139 140 140 141 141 141 141 142 143 144 144 145 145 146
15.1 DESCRIPTIVES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.2 FREQUENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.3 EXAMINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.4 CORRELATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.5 CROSSTABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6 FACTOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.7 LOGISTIC REGRESSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.8 MEANS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9 NPAR TESTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.1 Binomial test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.2 Chisquare Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.3 Cochran Q Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.4 Friedman Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.5 Kendalls W Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.6 Kolmogorov-Smirnov Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.7 Kruskal-Wallis Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.8 Mann-Whitney U Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.9 McNemar Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.10 Median Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.11 Runs Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.12 Sign Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9.13 Wilcoxon Matched Pairs Signed Ranks Test . . . . . . . . . . . 15.10 T-TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.10.1 One Sample Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.10.2 Independent Samples Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.10.3 Paired Samples Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.11 ONEWAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.12 QUICK CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.13 RANK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.14 REGRESSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.14.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.14.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.15 RELIABILITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.16 ROC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
16
Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
ADD DOCUMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CACHE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COMMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DOCUMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISPLAY DOCUMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISPLAY FILE LABEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DROP DOCUMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ECHO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ERASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EXECUTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 148 148 148 148 149 149 149 149 149 149
16.1 16.2 16.3 16.4 16.5 16.6 16.7 16.8 16.9 16.10 16.11
vi 16.12 16.13 16.14 16.15 16.16 16.17 16.18 16.19 16.20 16.21 16.22 FILE LABEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FINISH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HOST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . INCLUDE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . INSERT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PERMISSIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PRESERVE and RESTORE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SHOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SUBTITLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TITLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 150 150 150 150 151 152 152 158 160 160
17 18 19 20 21
Not Implemented . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Bugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Function Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Command Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Concept Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Chapter 1: Introduction
1 Introduction
pspp is a tool for statistical analysis of sampled data. It reads the data, analyzes the data according to commands provided, and writes the results to a listing file, to the standard output or to a window of the graphical display. The language accepted by pspp is similar to those accepted by SPSS statistical products. The details of pspps language are given later in this manual. pspp produces tables and charts as output, which it can produce in several formats; currently, ASCII, PostScript, PDF, HTML, and DocBook are supported. The current version of pspp, 0.7.9-gb6493c, is incomplete in terms of its statistical procedure support. pspp is a work in progress. The authors hope to fully support all features in the products that pspp replaces, eventually. The authors welcome questions, comments, donations, and code submissions. See Chapter 18 [Submitting Bug Reports], page 166, for instructions on contacting the authors.
3 Invoking pspp
pspp has two separate user interfaces. This chapter describes pspp, pspps command-line driven text-based user interface. The following chapter briefly describes PSPPIRE, the graphical user interface to pspp. The sections below describe the pspp programs command-line interface.
Specify this option more than once to produce multiple output files, presumably in different formats. Use - as output-file to write output to standard output. If no -o option is used, then pspp writes output to standard output in plain text format. -O option =value Sets an option for the output file configured by a preceding -o. Most options are specific to particular output formats. A few options that apply generically are listed below. -O format=format pspp uses the extension of the file name given on -o to select an output format. Use this option to override this choice by specifying an alternate format, e.g. -o pspp.out -O html to write HTML to a file named pspp.out. Use --help to list the available formats. -O device={terminal|listing} Sets whether pspp considers the output device configured by the preceding -o to be a terminal or a listing device. This affects what output will be sent to the device, as configured by the SET commands output routing subcommands (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152). By default, output written to standard output is considered a terminal device and other output is considered a listing device. --no-output Disables output entirely, if neither -o nor -O is also used. If one of those options is used, --no-output has no effect. -e error-file --error-file=error-file Configures a file to receive pspp error, warning, and note messages in plain text format. Use - as error-file to write messages to standard output. The default error file is standard output in the absence of these options, but this is suppressed if an output device writes to standard output (or another terminal), to avoid printing every message twice. Use none as error-file to explicitly suppress the default. -I dir --include=dir Appends dir to the set of directories searched by the INCLUDE (see Section 16.15 [INCLUDE], page 150) and INSERT (see Section 16.16 [INSERT], page 150) commands. -I- --no-include Clears all directories from the include path, including directories inserted in the include path by default. The default include path is . (the current directory), followed by .pspp in the users home directory, followed by pspps system configuration directory (usually /etc/pspp or /usr/local/etc/pspp).
-b --batch -i --interactive These options forces syntax files to be interpreted in batch mode or interactive mode, respectively, rather than the default auto mode. See Section 6.3 [Syntax Variants], page 28, for a description of the differences. -r --no-statrc Disables running rc at pspp startup time. -a {enhanced|compatible} --algorithm={enhanced|compatible} With enhanced, the default, pspp uses the best implemented algorithms for statistical procedures. With compatible, however, pspp will in some cases use inferior algorithms to produce the same results as the proprietary program SPSS. Some commands have subcommands that override this setting on a per command basis. -x {enhanced|compatible} --syntax={enhanced|compatible} With enhanced, the default, pspp accepts its own extensions beyond those compatible with the proprietary program SPSS. With compatible, pspp rejects syntax that uses these extensions. --syntax-encoding=encoding Specifies encoding as the encoding for syntax files named on the command line. The encoding also becomes the default encoding for other syntax files read during the pspp session by the INCLUDE and INSERT commands. See Section 16.16 [INSERT], page 150, for the accepted forms of encoding. --help Prints a message describing pspp command-line syntax and the available device formats, then exits.
-V --version Prints a brief message listing pspps version, warranties you dont have, copying conditions and copyright, and e-mail address for bug reports, then exits. -s --safer Disables certain unsafe operations. This includes the ERASE and HOST commands, as well as use of pipes as input and output files.
--testing-mode Invoke heuristics to assist with testing pspp. For use by make check and similar scripts.
-O prop-font=font-name -O emph-font=font-name -O fixed-font=font-name Sets the font used for proportional, emphasized, or fixed-pitch text. Most systems support CSS-like font names such as serif and monospace, but a wide range of system-specific font are likely to be supported as well. Default: proportional font serif, emphasis font serif italic, fixed-pitch font monospace. -O font-size=font-size Sets the size of the default fonts, in thousandths of a point. Default: 10000 (10 point).
-O line-gutter=dimension Sets the width of white space on either side of lines that border text or graphics objects. Default: 1pt. -O line-spacing=dimension Sets the spacing between the lines in a double line in a table. Default: 1pt. -O line-width=dimension Sets the width of the lines used in tables. Default: 0.5pt. Each dimension value above may be specified in various units based on its suffix: mm for millimeters, in for inches, or pt for points. Lacking a suffix, numbers below 50 are assumed to be in inches and those about 50 are assumed to be in millimeters.
-O top-margin=top-margin-lines Length of the top margin, in lines. pspp subtracts this value from the page length. Default: 0. -O bottom-margin=bottom-margin-lines Length of the bottom margin, in lines. pspp subtracts this value from the page length. Default: 0. -O box={ascii|unicode} Sets the characters used for lines in tables. The default, ascii, uses -, |, and + for single-width lines and = and # for double-width lines. Specify unicode to use Unicode box drawing characters. -O emphasis={none|bold|underline} How to emphasize text. Bold and underline emphasis are achieved with overstriking, which may not be supported by all the software to which you might pass the output. Default: none.
10
11
4 Invoking psppire
4.1 The graphic user interface
The PSPPIRE graphic user interface for pspp can perform all functionality of the command line interface. In addition it gives an instantaneous view of the data, variables and statistical output. The graphic user interface can be started by typing psppire at a command prompt. Alternatively many systems have a system of interactive menus or buttons from which psppire can be started by a series of mouse clicks. Once the principles of the pspp system are understood, the graphic user interface is designed to be largely intuitive, and for this reason is covered only very briefly by this manual.
12
5 Using pspp
pspp is a tool for the statistical analysis of sampled data. You can use it to discover patterns in the data, to explain differences in one subset of data in terms of another subset and to find out whether certain beliefs about the data are justified. This chapter does not attempt to introduce the theory behind the statistical analysis, but it shows how such analysis can be performed using pspp. For the purposes of this tutorial, it is assumed that you are using pspp in its interactive mode from the command line. However, the example commands can also be typed into a file and executed in a post-hoc mode by typing pspp filename at a shell prompt, where filename is the name of the file containing the commands. Alternatively, from the graphical interface, you can select File New Syntax to open a new syntax window and use the Run menu when a syntax fragment is ready to be executed. Whichever method you choose, the syntax is identical. When using the interactive method, pspp tells you that its waiting for your data with a string like PSPP> or data>. In the examples of this chapter, whenever you see text like this, it indicates the prompt displayed by pspp, not something that you should type. Throughout this chapter reference is made to a number of sample data files. So that you can try the examples for yourself, you should have received these files along with your copy of pspp.1 Please note: Normally these files are installed in the directory /usr/local/share/pspp/examples. If however your system administrator or operating system vendor has chosen to install them in a different location, you will have to adjust the examples accordingly.
These files contain purely fictitious data. They should not be used for research purposes.
13
PSPP> data list list /forename (A12) height. PSPP> begin data. data> Ahmed 188 data> Bertram 167 data> Catherine 134.231 data> David 109.1 data> end data PSPP>
Example 5.1: Manual entry of data using the DATA LIST command. Two variables forename and height are defined and subsequently filled with manually entered data. There are several things to note about this example. The words data list list are an example of the DATA LIST command. See Section 8.5 [DATA LIST], page 64. It tells pspp to prepare for reading data. The word list intentionally appears twice. The first occurrence is part of the DATA LIST call, whilst the second tells pspp that the data is to be read as free format data with one record per line. The / character is important. It marks the start of the list of variables which you wish to define. The text forename is the name of the first variable, and (A12) says that the variable forename is a string variable and that its maximum length is 12 bytes. The second variables name is specified by the text height. Since no format is given, this variable has the default format. For more information on data formats, see Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32. Normally, pspp displays the prompt PSPP> whenever its expecting a command. However, when its expecting data, the prompt changes to data> so that you know to enter data and not a command. At the end of every command there is a terminating . which tells pspp that the end of a command has been encountered. You should not enter . when data is expected (ie. when the data> prompt is current) since it is appropriate only for terminating commands.
14
to list the data. The optional text /format=numbered requests the case numbers to be shown along with the data. It should show the following output: Case# forename height ----- ------------ -------1 Ahmed 188.00 2 Bertram 167.00 3 Catherine 134.23 4 David 109.10 Note that the numeric variable height is displayed to 2 decimal places, because the format for that variable is F8.2. For a complete description of the LIST command, see Section 8.10 [LIST], page 73.
15
The following syntax will save the existing data and variables to a file called my-new-file.sav. PSPP> save outfile=my-new-file.sav. If my-new-file.sav already exists, then it will be overwritten. Otherwise it will be created.
PSPP> get file=/usr/local/share/pspp/examples/physiology.sav. PSPP> descriptives sex, weight, height. Output: DESCRIPTIVES. Valid cases = 40; cases with missing value(s) = 0. +--------#--+-------+-------+-------+-------+ |Variable# N| Mean |Std Dev|Minimum|Maximum| #========#==#=======#=======#=======#=======# |sex #40| .45| .50| .00| 1.00| |height #40|1677.12| 262.87| 179.00|1903.00| |weight #40| 72.12| 26.70| -55.60| 92.07| +--------#--+-------+-------+-------+-------+
Example 5.2: Using the DESCRIPTIVES command to display simple summary information about the data. In this case, the results show unexpectedly low values in the Minimum column, suggesting incorrect data entry. In the output of Example 5.2, the most interesting column is the minimum value. The weight variable has a minimum value of less than zero, which is clearly erroneous. Similarly,
Chapter 5: Using
16
the height variables minimum value seems to be very low. In fact, it is more than 5 standard deviations from the mean, and is a seemingly bizarre height for an adult person. We can examine the data in more detail with the EXAMINE command (see Section 15.3 [EXAMINE], page 125): In Example 5.3 you can see that the lowest value of height is 179 (which we suspect to be erroneous), but the second lowest is 1598 which we know from the DESCRIPTIVES command is within 1 standard deviation from the mean. Similarly the weight variable has a lowest value which is negative but a plausible value for the second lowest value. This suggests that the two extreme values are outliers and probably represent data entry errors.
[. . . continue from Example 5.2] PSPP> examine height, weight /statistics=extreme(3). Output: #===============================#===========#=======# # #Case Number| Value # #===============================#===========#=======# #Height in millimetres Highest 1# 14|1903.00# # 2# 15|1884.00# # 3# 12|1801.65# # ----------#-----------+-------# # Lowest 1# 30| 179.00# # 2# 31|1598.00# # 3# 28|1601.00# # ----------#-----------+-------# #Weight in kilograms Highest 1# 13| 92.07# # 2# 5| 92.07# # 3# 17| 91.74# # ----------#-----------+-------# # Lowest 1# 38| -55.60# # 2# 39| 54.48# # 3# 33| 55.45# #===============================#===========#=======#
Example 5.3: Using the EXAMINE command to see the extremities of the data for different variables. Cases 30 and 38 seem to contain values very much lower than the rest of the data. They are possibly erroneous.
17
> recode height (179 = SYSMIS). pspp > recode weight (LOWEST THRU 0 = SYSMIS). The first command says that for any observation which has a height value of 179, that value should be changed to the SYSMIS value. The second command says that any weight values of zero or less should be changed to SYSMIS. From now on, they will be ignored in analysis. For detailed information about the RECODE command see Section 12.7 [RECODE], page 112. If you now re-run the DESCRIPTIVES or EXAMINE commands in Example 5.2 and Example 5.3 you will see a data summary with more plausible parameters. You will also notice that the data summaries indicate the two missing values.
18
PSPP> get file=/usr/local/share/pspp/examples/hotel.sav. PSPP> display dictionary. PSPP> * recode negatively worded questions. PSPP> compute v3 = 6 - v3. PSPP> compute v5 = 6 - v5. PSPP> reliability v1, v3, v5. Output (dictionary information omitted for clarity): 1.1 RELIABILITY. Case Processing Summary #==============#==#======# # # N| % # #==============#==#======# #Cases Valid #17|100.00# # Excluded# 0| .00# # Total #17|100.00# #==============#==#======# 1.2 RELIABILITY. Reliability Statistics #================#==========# #Cronbachs Alpha#N of Items# #================#==========# # .86# 3# #================#==========#
Example 5.4: Recoding negatively scaled variables, and testing for reliability with the RELIABILITY command. The Cronbach Alpha coefficient suggests a high degree of reliability among variables v1, v2 and v5. As a rule of thumb, many statisticians consider a value of Cronbachs Alpha of 0.7 or higher to indicate reliable data. Here, the value is 0.86 so the data and the recoding that we performed are vindicated.
19
compensated for by applying a logarithmic transformation. This is done with the COMPUTE command in the line
Rather than redefining the existing variable, this use of COMPUTE defines a new variable mtbf ln which is the natural logarithm of mtbf. The final command in this example calls EXAMINE on this new variable, and it can be seen from the results that both the skewness and kurtosis for mtbf ln are very close to zero. This provides some confidence that the mtbf ln variable is normally distributed and thus safe for linear analysis. In the event that no suitable transformation can be found, then it would be worth considering an appropriate non-parametric test instead of a linear one. See Section 15.9 [NPAR TESTS], page 136, for information about non-parametric tests.
20
PSPP> get file=/usr/local/share/pspp/examples/repairs.sav. PSPP> examine mtbf /statistics=descriptives. PSPP> compute mtbf_ln = ln (mtbf). PSPP> examine mtbf_ln /statistics=descriptives. Output: 1.2 EXAMINE. Descriptives #====================================================#=========#==========# # #Statistic|Std. Error# #====================================================#=========#==========# #mtbf Mean # 8.32 | 1.62 # # 95% Confidence Interval for Mean Lower Bound# 4.85 | # # Upper Bound# 11.79 | # # 5% Trimmed Mean # 7.69 | # # Median # 8.12 | # # Variance # 39.21 | # # Std. Deviation # 6.26 | # # Minimum # 1.63 | # # Maximum # 26.47 | # # Range # 24.84 | # # Interquartile Range # 5.83 | # # Skewness # 1.85 | .58 # # Kurtosis # 4.49 | 1.12 # #====================================================#=========#==========# 2.2 EXAMINE. Descriptives #====================================================#=========#==========# # #Statistic|Std. Error# #====================================================#=========#==========# #mtbf_ln Mean # 1.88 | .19 # # 95% Confidence Interval for Mean Lower Bound# 1.47 | # # Upper Bound# 2.29 | # # 5% Trimmed Mean # 1.88 | # # Median # 2.09 | # # Variance # .54 | # # Std. Deviation # .74 | # # Minimum # .49 | # # Maximum # 3.28 | # # Range # 2.79 | # # Interquartile Range # .92 | # # Skewness # -.16 | .58 # # Kurtosis # -.09 | 1.12 # #====================================================#=========#==========#
Example 5.5: Testing for normality using the EXAMINE command and applying a logarithmic transformation. The mtbf variable has a large positive skew and is therefore unsuitable for linear statistical analysis. However the transformed variable (mtbf ln) is close to normal and would appear to be more suitable.
21
This example assumes that it is already proven that B is not greater than A.
22
PSPP> get file=/usr/local/share/pspp/examples/physiology.sav. PSPP> recode height (179 = SYSMIS). PSPP> t-test group=sex(0,1) /variables = height temperature. Output: 1.1 T-TEST. Group Statistics #==================#==#=======#==============#========# # sex | N| Mean |Std. Deviation|SE. Mean# #==================#==#=======#==============#========# #height Male |22|1796.49| 49.71| 10.60# # Female|17|1610.77| 25.43| 6.17# #temperature Male |22| 36.68| 1.95| .42# # Female|18| 37.43| 1.61| .38# #==================#==#=======#==============#========# 1.2 T-TEST. Independent Samples Test #===========================#=========#=============================== =# # # Levenes| t-test for Equality of Means # # #----+----+------+-----+------+---------+-# # # | | | | | | # # # | | | |Sig. 2| | # # # F |Sig.| t | df |tailed|Mean Diff| # #===========================#====#====#======#=====#======#=========#= =# #height Equal variances# .97| .33| 14.02|37.00| .00| 185.72| ... # # Unequal variances# | | 15.15|32.71| .00| 185.72| ... # #temperature Equal variances# .31| .58| -1.31|38.00| .20| -.75| ... # # Unequal variances# | | -1.33|37.99| .19| -.75| ... # #===========================#====#====#======#=====#======#=========#= =#
Example 5.6: The T-TEST command tests for differences of means. Here, the height variables two tailed significance is less than 0.05, so the null hypothesis can be rejected. Thus, the evidence suggests there is a difference between the heights of male and female persons. However the significance of the test for the temperature variable is greater than 0.05 so the null hypothesis cannot be rejected, and there is insufficient evidence to suggest a difference in body temperature.
23
not only tests if the variables are related, but also identifies the potential linear relationship. See Section 15.14 [REGRESSION], page 144.
24
PSPP> get file=/usr/local/share/pspp/examples/repairs.sav. PSPP> regression /variables = mtbf duty_cycle /dependent = mttr. PSPP> regression /variables = mtbf /dependent = mttr. Output: 1.3(1) REGRESSION. Coefficients #=============================================#====#==========#====#=====# # # B |Std. Error|Beta| t # #========#====================================#====#==========#====#=====# # |(Constant) #9.81| 1.50| .00| 6.54# # |Mean time between failures (months) #3.10| .10| .99|32.43# # |Ratio of working to non-working time#1.09| 1.78| .02| .61# # | # | | | # #========#====================================#====#==========#====#=====# 1.3(2) REGRESSION. Coefficients #=============================================#============# # #Significance# #========#====================================#============# # |(Constant) # .10# # |Mean time between failures (months) # .00# # |Ratio of working to non-working time# .55# # | # # #========#====================================#============# 2.3(1) REGRESSION. Coefficients #============================================#=====#==========#====#=====# # # B |Std. Error|Beta| t # #========#===================================#=====#==========#====#=====# # |(Constant) #10.50| .96| .00|10.96# # |Mean time between failures (months)# 3.11| .09| .99|33.39# # | # | | | # #========#===================================#=====#==========#====#=====# 2.3(2) REGRESSION. Coefficients #============================================#============# # #Significance# #========#===================================#============# # |(Constant) # .06# # |Mean time between failures (months)# .00# # | # # #========#===================================#============#
Example 5.7: Linear regression analysis to find a predictor for mttr. The first attempt, including duty cycle, produces some unacceptable high significance values. However the second attempt, which excludes duty cycle, produces significance values no higher than 0.06. This suggests that mtbf alone may be a suitable predictor for mttr.
25
The coefficients in the first table suggest that the formula mttr = 9.81 + 3.1 mtbf + 1.09 duty cycle can be used to predict the time to repair. However, the significance value for the duty cycle coefficient is very high, which would make this an unsafe predictor. For this reason, the test was repeated, but omitting the duty cycle variable. This time, the significance of all coefficients no higher than 0.06, suggesting that at the 0.06 level, the formula mttr = 10.5 + 3.11 mtbf is a reliable predictor of the time to repair.
26
6.1 Tokens
pspp divides most syntax file lines into series of short chunks called tokens. Tokens are then grouped to form commands, each of which tells pspp to take some actionread in data, write out data, perform a statistical procedure, etc. Each type of token is described below. Identifiers Identifiers are names that typically specify variables, commands, or subcommands. The first character in an identifier must be a letter, #, or @. The remaining characters in the identifier must be letters, digits, or one of the following special characters: . _ $ # @ Identifiers may be any length, but only the first 64 bytes are significant. Identifiers are not case-sensitive: foobar, Foobar, FooBar, FOOBAR, and FoObaR are different representations of the same identifier. Some identifiers are reserved. Reserved identifiers may not be used in any context besides those explicitly described in this manual. The reserved identifiers are: ALL AND BY EQ GE GT LE LT NE NOT OR TO WITH Keywords Keywords are a subclass of identifiers that form a fixed part of command syntax. For example, command and subcommand names are keywords. Keywords may be abbreviated to their first 3 characters if this abbreviation is unambiguous. (Unique abbreviations of 3 or more characters are also accepted: FRE, FREQ, and FREQUENCIES are equivalent when the last is a keyword.) Reserved identifiers are always used as keywords. Other identifiers may be used both as keywords and as user-defined identifiers, such as variable names. Numbers Numbers are expressed in decimal. A decimal point is optional. Numbers may be expressed in scientific notation by adding e and a base-10 exponent, so that 1.234e3 has the value 1234. Here are some more examples of valid numbers: -5 3.14159265359 1e100 -.707 8945. Negative numbers are expressed with a - prefix. However, in situations where a literal - token is expected, what appears to be a negative number is treated as - followed by a positive number. No white space is allowed within a number token, except for horizontal white space between - and the rest of the number. The last example above, 8945. will be interpreted as two tokens, 8945 and ., if it is the last token on a line. See Section 6.2 [Forming commands of tokens], page 27. Strings are literal sequences of characters enclosed in pairs of single quotes () or double quotes ("). To include the character used for quoting in the string,
Strings
27
double it, e.g. its an apostrophe. White space and case of letters are significant inside strings. Strings can be concatenated using +, so that "a" + b + c is equivalent to abc. So that a long string may be broken across lines, a line break may precede or follow, or both precede and follow, the +. (However, an entirely blank line preceding or following the + is interpreted as ending the current command.) Strings may also be expressed as hexadecimal character values by prefixing the initial quote character by x or X. Regardless of the syntax file or active datasets encoding, the hexadecimal digits in the string are interpreted as Unicode characters in UTF-8 encoding. Individual Unicode code points may also be expressed by specifying the hexadecimal code point number in single or double quotes preceded by u or U. For example, Unicode code point U+1D11E, the musical G clef character, could be expressed as U1D11E. Invalid Unicode code points (above U+10FFFF or in between U+D800 and U+DFFF) are not allowed. When strings are concatenated with +, each segments prefix is considered individually. For example, The G clef symbol is: + u"1d11e" + "." inserts a G clef symbol in the middle of an otherwise plain text string. Punctuators and Operators These tokens are the punctuators and operators: , / = ( ) + - * / ** < <= <> > >= ~= & | . Most of these appear within the syntax of commands, but the period (.) punctuator is used only at the end of a command. It is a punctuator only as the last character on a line (except white space). When it is the last non-space character on a line, a period is not treated as part of another token, even if it would otherwise be part of, e.g., an identifier or a floating-point number.
28
29
Procedures Analyze data, writing results of analyses to the listing file. Cause transformations specified earlier in the file to be performed. In a more general sense, a procedure is any command that causes the active dataset (the data) to be read.
30
Cause a transition to the transformation state. Procedures Invalid in initial, input-program, and file-type states. Cause a transition to the procedure state.
6.7 Datasets
pspp works with data organized into datasets. A dataset consists of a set of variables, which taken together are said to form a dictionary, and one or more cases, each of which has one value for each variable. At any given time pspp has exactly one distinguished dataset, called the active dataset. Most pspp commands work only with the active dataset. In addition to the active dataset, pspp also supports any number of additional open datasets. The DATASET commands can choose a new active dataset from among those that are open, as well as create and destroy datasets (see Section 8.4 [DATASET], page 63). The sections below describe variables in more detail.
31
The final character in a variable name should not be _, because some such identifiers are used for special purposes by pspp procedures. As with all pspp identifiers, variable names are not case-sensitive. pspp capitalizes variable names on output the same way they were capitalized at their point of definition in the input. Type Width Numeric or string. (string variables only) String variables with a width of 8 characters or fewer are called short string variables. Short string variables may be used in a few contexts where long string variables (those with widths greater than 8) are not allowed. Variables in the dictionary are arranged in a specific order. DISPLAY can be used to show this order: see Section 11.3 [DISPLAY], page 97.
Position
Initialization Either reinitialized to 0 or spaces for each case, or left at its existing value. See Section 11.5 [LEAVE], page 98. Missing values Optionally, up to three values, or a range of values, or a specific value plus a range, can be specified as user-missing values. There is also a system-missing value that is assigned to an observation when there is no other obvious value for that observation. Observations with missing values are automatically excluded from analyses. User-missing values are actual data values, while the systemmissing value is not a value at all. See Section 6.6 [Missing Observations], page 30. Variable label A string that describes the variable. See Section 11.15 [VARIABLE LABELS], page 104. Value label Optionally, these associate each possible value of the variable with a string. See Section 11.12 [VALUE LABELS], page 102. Print format Display width, format, and (for numeric variables) number of decimal places. This attribute does not affect how data are stored, just how they are displayed. Example: a width of 8, with 2 decimal places. See Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32. Write format Similar to print format, but used by the WRITE command (see Section 8.17 [WRITE], page 78). Custom attributes User-defined associations between names and values. See Section 11.14 [VARIABLE ATTRIBUTE], page 103.
32
33
Every variable has two output formats, called its print format and write format. Print formats are used in most output contexts; write formats are used only by WRITE (see Section 8.17 [WRITE], page 78). Newly created variables have identical print and write formats, and FORMATS, the most commonly used command for changing formats (see Section 11.4 [FORMATS], page 98), sets both of them to the same value as well. Thus, most of the time, the distinction between print and write formats is unimportant. Input and output formats are specified to pspp with a format specification of the form TYPE w or TYPEw.d , where TYPE is one of the format types described later, w is a field width measured in columns, and d is an optional number of decimal places. If d is omitted, a value of 0 is assumed. Some formats do not allow a nonzero d to be specified. The following sections describe the input and output formats supported by pspp.
On output, numbers in F format are expressed in standard decimal notation with the requested number of decimal places. The other formats output some variation on this style: Numbers in COMMA format are additionally grouped every three digits by inserting a grouping character. The grouping character is ordinarily a comma, but it can be changed to a period (see [SET DECIMAL], page 154). DOT format is like COMMA format, but it interchanges the role of the decimal point and grouping characters. That is, the current grouping character is used as a decimal point and vice versa. DOLLAR format is like COMMA format, but it prefixes the number with $. PCT format is like F format, but adds % after the number. The E format always produces output in scientific notation. On input, the basic numeric formats accept positive and numbers in standard decimal notation or scientific notation. Leading and trailing spaces are allowed. An empty or allspaces field, or one that contains only a single period, is treated as the system missing value. In scientific notation, the exponent may be introduced by a sign (+ or -), or by one of the letters e or d (in uppercase or lowercase), or by a letter followed by a sign. A single space may follow the letter or the sign or both.
34
On fixed-format DATA LIST (see Section 8.5.1 [DATA LIST FIXED], page 64) and in a few other contexts, decimals are implied when the field does not contain a decimal point. In F6.5 format, for example, the field 314159 is taken as the value 3.14159 with implied decimals. Decimals are never implied if an explicit decimal point is present or if scientific notation is used. E and F formats accept the basic syntax already described. The other formats allow some additional variations: COMMA, DOLLAR, and DOT formats ignore grouping characters within the integer part of the input field. The identity of the grouping character depends on the format. DOLLAR format allows a dollar sign to precede the number. In a negative number, the dollar sign may precede or follow the minus sign. PCT format allows a percent sign to follow the number. All of the basic number formats have a maximum field width of 40 and accept no more than 16 decimal places, on both input and output. Some additional restrictions apply: As input formats, the basic numeric formats allow no more decimal places than the field width. As output formats, the field width must be greater than the number of decimal places; that is, large enough to allow for a decimal point and the number of requested decimal places. DOLLAR and PCT formats must allow an additional column for $ or %. The default output format for a given input format increases the field width enough to make room for optional input characters. If an input format calls for decimal places, the width is increased by 1 to make room for an implied decimal point. COMMA, DOT, and DOLLAR formats also increase the output width to make room for grouping characters. DOLLAR and PCT further increase the output field width by 1 to make room for $ or %. The increased output width is capped at 40, the maximum field width. The E format is exceptional. For output, E format has a minimum width of 7 plus the number of decimal places. The default output format for an E input format is an E format with at least 3 decimal places and thus a minimum width of 10. More details of basic numeric output formatting are given below: Output rounds to nearest, with ties rounded away from zero. Thus, 2.5 is output as 3 in F1.0 format, and -1.125 as -1.13 in F5.1 format. The system-missing value is output as a period in a field of spaces, placed in the decimal points position, or in the rightmost column if no decimal places are requested. A period is used even if the decimal point character is a comma. A number that does not fill its field is right-justified within the field. A number is too large for its field causes decimal places to be dropped to make room. If dropping decimals does not make enough room, scientific notation is used if the field is wide enough. If a number does not fit in the field, even in scientific notation, the overflow is indicated by filling the field with asterisks (*). COMMA, DOT, and DOLLAR formats insert grouping characters only if space is available for all of them. Grouping characters are never inserted when all decimal places must be dropped. Thus, 1234.56 in COMMA5.2 format is output as 1235
35
without a comma, even though there is room for one, because all decimal places were dropped. DOLLAR or PCT format drop the $ or % only if the number would not fit at all without it. Scientific notation with $ or % is preferred to ordinary decimal notation without it. Except in scientific notation, a decimal point is included only when it is followed by a digit. If the integer part of the number being output is 0, and a decimal point is included, then the zero before the decimal point is dropped. In scientific notation, the number always includes a decimal point, even if it is not followed by a digit. A negative number includes a minus sign only in the presence of a nonzero digit: -0.01 is output as -.01 in F4.2 format but as .0 in F4.1 format. Thus, a negative zero never includes a minus sign. In negative numbers output in DOLLAR format, the dollar sign follows the negative sign. Thus, -9.99 in DOLLAR6.2 format is output as -$9.99. In scientific notation, the exponent is output as E followed by + or - and exactly three digits. Numbers with magnitude less than 10**-999 or larger than 10**999 are not supported by most computers, but if they are supported then their output is considered to overflow the field and will be output as asterisks. On most computers, no more than 15 decimal digits are significant in output, even if more are printed. In any case, output precision cannot be any higher than input precision; few data sets are accurate to 15 digits of precision. Unavoidable loss of precision in intermediate calculations may also reduce precision of output. Special values such as infinities and not a number values are usually converted to the system-missing value before printing. In a few circumstances, these values are output directly. In fields of width 3 or greater, special values are output as however many characters will fit from +Infinity or -Infinity for infinities, from NaN for not a number, or from Unknown for other values (if any are supported by the system). In fields under 3 columns wide, special values are output as asterisks.
36
The following syntax shows how custom currency formats could be used to reproduce basic numeric formats: SET CCA="-,,,". /* Same as COMMA. SET CCB="-...". /* Same as DOT. SET CCC="-,$,,". /* Same as DOLLAR. SET CCD="-,,%,". /* Like PCT, but groups with commas. Here are some more examples of custom currency formats. The final example shows how to use a single quote to escape a delimiter: SET CCA=",EUR,,-". /* Euro. SET CCB="(,USD ,,)". /* US dollar. SET CCC="-.R$..". /* Brazilian real. SET CCD="-,, NIS,". /* Israel shekel. SET CCE="-.Rp. ..". /* Indonesia Rupiah. These formats would yield the following output:
Format 3145.59 -3145.59 CCA12.2 EUR3,145.59 EUR3,145.59CCB14.2 USD 3,145.59 (USD 3,145.59) CCC11.2 R$3.145,59 -R$3.145,59 CCD13.2 3,145.59 NIS -3,145.59 NIS CCE10.0 Rp. 3.146 -Rp. 3.146 The default for all the custom currency formats is -,,,, equivalent to COMMA format.
37
N Format
The N format supports input and output of fields that contain only digits. On input, leading or trailing spaces, a decimal point, or any other non-digit character causes the field to be read as the system-missing value. As a special exception, an N format used on DATA LIST FREE or DATA LIST LIST is treated as the equivalent F format. On output, N pads the field on the left with zeros. Negative numbers are output like the system-missing value.
Z Format
The Z format is a zoned decimal format used on IBM mainframes. Z format encodes the sign as part of the final digit, which must be one of the following: 0123456789 {ABCDEFGHI }JKLMNOPQR where the characters in each row represent digits 0 through 9 in order. Characters in the first two rows indicate a positive sign; those in the third indicate a negative sign. On output, Z fields are padded on the left with spaces. On input, leading and trailing spaces are ignored. Any character in an input field other than spaces, the digit characters above, and . causes the field to be read as system-missing. The decimal point character for input and output is always ., even if the decimal point character is a comma (see [SET DECIMAL], page 154). Nonzero, negative values output in Z format are marked as negative even when no nonzero digits are output. For example, -0.2 is output in Z1.0 format as J. The negative zero value supported by most machines is output as positive.
P and PK Formats
These are binary-coded decimal formats, in which every byte (except the last, in P format) represents two decimal digits. The most-significant 4 bits of the first byte is the mostsignificant decimal digit, the least-significant 4 bits of the first byte is the next decimal digit, and so on. In P format, the most-significant 4 bits of the last byte are the least-significant decimal digit. The least-significant 4 bits represent the sign: decimal 15 indicates a negative value, decimal 13 indicates a positive value.
38
Numbers are rounded downward on output. The system-missing value and numbers outside representable range are output as zero. The maximum field width is 16. Decimal places may range from 0 up to the number of decimal digits represented by the field. The default output format is an F format with twice the input field width, plus one column for a decimal point (if decimal places were requested).
RB Format
This is a binary format for real numbers. By default it reads and writes the host machines floating-point format, but SET RRB may be used to select an alternate floating-point format for reading (see [SET RRB], page 154) and SET WRB, similarly, for writing (see [SET WRB], page 156). The recommended field width depends on the floating-point format. NATIVE (the default format), IDL, IDB, VD, VG, and ZL formats should use a field width of 8. ISL, ISB, VF, and ZS formats should use a field width of 4. Other field widths will not produce useful results. The maximum field width is 8. No decimal places may be specified. The default output format is F8.2.
39
Time Format Template Example TIME hh:MM:SS.ss 04:31:17.01 DTIME DD HH:MM:SS.ss 00 04:31:17.01 A date is a moment in the past or the future. Internally, pspp represents a date as the number of seconds since the epoch, midnight, Oct. 14, 1582. The date formats translate between human-readable dates and pspps numeric representation of dates and times. pspp has several date formats:
Date Format Template Example DATE dd-mmm-yyyy 01-OCT-1978 ADATE mm/dd/yyyy 10/01/1978 EDATE dd.mm.yyyy 01.10.1978 JDATE yyyyjjj 1978274 SDATE yyyy/mm/dd 1978/10/01 QYR q Q yyyy 3 Q 1978 MOYR mmm yyyy OCT 1978 WKYR ww WK yyyy 40 WK 1978 DATETIME dd-mmm-yyyy HH:MM:SS.ss 01-OCT-1978 04:31:17.01 The templates in the preceding tables describe how the time and date formats are input and output: dd mm mmm Day of month, from 1 to 31. Always output as two digits. Month. In output, mm is output as two digits, mmm as the first three letters of an English month name (January, February, . . . ). In input, both of these formats, plus Roman numerals, are accepted. Year. In output, DATETIME always produces a 4-digit year; other formats can produce a 2- or 4-digit year. The century assumed for 2-digit years depends on the EPOCH setting (see [SET EPOCH], page 154). In output, a year outside the epoch causes the whole field to be filled with asterisks (*). Day of year (Julian day), from 1 to 366. This is exactly three digits giving the count of days from the start of the year. January 1 is considered day 1. Quarter of year, from 1 to 4. Quarters start on January 1, April 1, July 1, and October 1. Week of year, from 1 to 53. Output as exactly two digits. January 1 is the first day of week 1. Count of days, which may be positive or negative. Output as at least two digits. Count of hours, which may be positive or negative. Output as at least two digits. Hour of day, from 0 to 23. Output as exactly two digits.
yyyy
jjj q ww DD hh HH
40
MM SS.ss
Minute of hour, from 0 to 59. Output as exactly two digits. Seconds within minute, from 0 to 59. The integer part is output as exactly two digits. On output, seconds and fractional seconds may or may not be included, depending on field width and decimal places. On input, seconds and fractional seconds are optional. The DECIMAL setting controls the character accepted and displayed as the decimal point (see [SET DECIMAL], page 154).
For output, the date and time formats use the delimiters indicated in the table. For input, date components may be separated by spaces or by one of the characters -, /, ., or ,, and time components may be separated by spaces, :, or .. On input, the Q separating quarter from year and the WK separating week from year may be uppercase or lowercase, and the spaces around them are optional. On input, all time and date formats accept any amount of leading and trailing white space. The maximum width for time and date formats is 40 columns. Minimum input and output width for each of the time and date formats is shown below:
Format Min. Input Width Min. Output Width Option DATE 8 9 4-digit year ADATE 8 8 4-digit year EDATE 8 8 4-digit year JDATE 5 5 4-digit year SDATE 8 8 4-digit year QYR 4 6 4-digit year MOYR 6 6 4-digit year WKYR 6 8 4-digit year DATETIME 17 17 seconds TIME 5 5 seconds DTIME 8 8 seconds In the table, Option describes what increased output width enables: 4-digit year A field 2 columns wider than minimum will include a 4-digit year. (DATETIME format always includes a 4-digit year.) seconds A field 3 columns wider than minimum will include seconds as well as minutes. A field 5 columns wider than minimum, or more, can also include a decimal point and fractional seconds (but no more than allowed by the formats decimal places).
For the time and date formats, the default output format is the same as the input format, except that pspp increases the field width, if necessary, to the minimum allowed for output. Time or dates narrower than the field width are right-justified within the field. When a time or date exceeds the field width, characters are trimmed from the end until it fits. This can occur in an unusual situation, e.g. with a year greater than 9999 (which adds an extra digit), or for a negative value on TIME or DTIME (which adds a leading minus sign).
41
The system-missing value is output as a period at the right end of the field.
42
command file syntax file These names (synonyms) refer to the file that contains instructions that tell pspp what to do. The syntax files name is specified on the pspp command line. Syntax files can also be read with INCLUDE (see Section 16.15 [INCLUDE], page 150). data file Data files contain raw data in text or binary format. Data can also be embedded in a syntax file with BEGIN DATA and END DATA.
listing file One or more output files are created by pspp each time it is run. The output files receive the tables and charts produced by statistical procedures. The output files may be in any number of formats, depending on how pspp is configured. system file System files are binary files that store a dictionary and a set of cases. GET and SAVE read and write system files. portable file Portable files are files in a text-based format that store a dictionary and a set of cases. IMPORT and EXPORT read and write portable files.
43
=, /, +, -, etc. Operators and punctuators. The end of the command. This is not necessarily an actual dot in the syntax file: See Section 6.2 [Commands], page 27, for more details. Other words in all lowercase refer to BNF definitions, called productions. These productions are also known as nonterminals. Some nonterminals are very common, so they are defined here in English for clarity: . var-list expression An expression. See Chapter 7 [Expressions], page 44, for details. ::= means is defined as. The left side of ::= gives the name of the nonterminal being defined. The right side of ::= gives the definition of that nonterminal. If the right side is empty, then one possible expansion of that nonterminal is nothing. A BNF definition is called a production. So, the key difference between a terminal and a nonterminal is that a terminal cannot be broken into smaller partsin fact, every terminal is a single token (see Section 6.1 [Tokens], page 26). On the other hand, nonterminals are composed of a (possibly empty) sequence of terminals and nonterminals. Thus, terminals indicate the deepest level of syntax description. (In parsing theory, terminals are the leaves of the parse tree; nonterminals form the branches.) The first nonterminal defined in a set of productions is called the start symbol. The start symbol defines the entire syntax for that command. A list of one or more variable names or the keyword ALL.
44
7 Mathematical Expressions
Expressions share a common syntax each place they appear in pspp commands. Expressions are made up of operands, which can be numbers, strings, or variable names, separated by operators. There are five types of operators: grouping, arithmetic, logical, relational, and functions. Every operator takes one or more operands as input and yields exactly one result as output. Depending on the operator, operands accept strings or numbers as operands. With few exceptions, operands may be full-fledged expressions in themselves.
45
a /b a ** b
Divides a by b and yields the quotient. If a is 0, then the result is 0, even if b is missing. If b is zero, the result is system-missing. Yields the result of raising a to the power b. If a is negative and b is not an integer, the result is system-missing. The result of 0**0 is system-missing as well. Reverses the sign of a.
-a
a OR b a |b
NOT a ~a
46
7.7 Functions
pspp functions provide mathematical abilities above and beyond those possible using simple operators. Functions have a common syntax: each is composed of a function name followed by a left parenthesis, one or more arguments, and a right parenthesis. Function names are not reserved. Their names are specially treated only when followed by a left parenthesis, so that EXP(10) refers to the constant value e raised to the 10th power, but EXP by itself refers to the value of a variable called EXP. The sections below describe each function in detail.
EXP (exponent )
Returns e (approximately 2.71828) raised to power exponent.
[Function]
LG10 (number )
[Function] Takes the base-10 logarithm of number. If number is not positive, the result is system-missing. [Function] Takes the base-e logarithm of number. If number is not positive, the result is systemmissing. [Function] Yields the base-e logarithm of the complete gamma of number. If number is a negative integer, the result is system-missing. [Function] Takes the square root of number. If number is negative, the result is system-missing.
LN (number )
LNGAMMA (number )
SQRT (number )
ABS (number )
Results in the absolute value of number.
[Function]
[Function] Returns the remainder (modulus) of numerator divided by denominator. If numerator is 0, then the result is 0, even if denominator is missing. If denominator is 0, the result is system-missing. Returns the remainder when number is divided by 10. MOD10(number ) is negative or zero. [Function] If number is negative,
MOD10 (number )
RND (number )
[Function] Takes the absolute value of number and rounds it to an integer. Then, if number was negative originally, negates the result. [Function] Discards the fractional part of number ; that is, rounds number towards zero.
TRUNC (number )
47
[Function] [Function] Takes the arccosine, in radians, of number. Results in system-missing if number is not between -1 and 1 inclusive. This function is a pspp extension. [Function] [Function] Takes the arcsine, in radians, of number. Results in system-missing if number is not between -1 and 1 inclusive. [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function]
COS (angle )
Takes the cosine of angle which should be in radians.
SIN (angle )
Takes the sine of angle which should be in radians.
TAN (angle )
[Function] Takes the tangent of angle which should be in radians. Results in system-missing at values of angle that are too close to odd multiples of /2. Portability: none.
MISSING (expr )
Returns 1 if expr has the system-missing value, 0 otherwise.
[Function]
[Function] Each argument must be a numeric expression. Returns the number of system-missing values in the list, which may include variable ranges using the var1 TO var2 syntax. [Function] Each argument must be a numeric expression. Returns the number of values in the list that are not system-missing. The list may include variable ranges using the var1 TO var2 syntax.
SYSMIS (expr )
[Function] When expr is simply the name of a numeric variable, returns 1 if the variable has the system-missing value, 0 if it is user-missing or not missing. If given expr takes another form, results in 1 if the value is system-missing, 0 otherwise.
48
VALUE (variable )
[Function] Prevents the user-missing values of variable from being transformed into systemmissing values, and always results in the actual value of variable, whether it is valid, user-missing, or system-missing.
[Function] Results in true if value is equal to any of the set values. Otherwise, results in false. If value is system-missing, returns system-missing. System-missing values in set do not cause /NAME/ to return system-missing. [Function] Results in true if value is in any of the intervals bounded by low and high inclusive. Otherwise, results in false. Each low must be less than or equal to its corresponding high value. low and high must be given in pairs. If value is system-missing, returns system-missing. System-missing values in set do not cause /NAME/ to return systemmissing.
[Function] Results in the coefficient of variation of the values of number. (The coefficient of variation is the standard deviation divided by the mean.) [Function] Results in the value of the greatest value. The value s may be numeric or string. [Function] Results in the mean of the values of number.
[Function] Results in the value of the least value. The value s may be numeric or string.
49
SD (number, number [, . . . ])
Results in the standard deviation of the values of number.
[Function] Returns a string consisting of each string in sequence. CONCAT("abc", "def", "ghi") has a value of "abcdefghi". The resultant string is truncated to a maximum of 255 characters.
[Function] Returns a positive integer indicating the position of the first occurrence of needle in haystack. Returns 0 if haystack does not contain needle. Returns system-missing if needle is an empty string.
[Function] Divides needles into one or more needles, each with length needle len. Searches haystack for the first occurrence of each needle, and returns the smallest value. Returns 0 if haystack does not contain any part in needle. It is an error if needle len does not evenly divide the length of needles. Returns system-missing if needles is an empty string. [Function] Returns the number of characters in string.
[Function] Returns a string identical to string except that all uppercase letters are changed to lowercase letters. The definitions of uppercase and lowercase are systemdependent. [Function] If string is at least length characters in length, returns string unchanged. Otherwise, returns string padded with spaces on the left side to length length. Returns an empty string if length is system-missing, negative, or greater than 255. [Function] If string is at least length characters in length, returns string unchanged. Otherwise, returns string padded with padding on the left side to length length. Returns an empty string if length is system-missing, negative, or greater than 255, or if padding does not contain exactly one character. [Function] Returns string, after removing leading spaces. Other white space, such as tabs, carriage returns, line feeds, and vertical tabs, is not removed.
LTRIM (string )
50
[Function] Returns string, after removing leading padding characters. If padding does not contain exactly one character, returns an empty string.
[Function] Returns the number produced when string is interpreted according to format specifier format. If the format width w is less than the length of string, then only the first w characters in string are used, e.g. NUMBER("123", F3.0) and NUMBER("1234", F3.0) both have value 123. If w is greater than string s length, then it is treated as if it were right-padded with spaces. If string is not in the correct format for format, system-missing is returned.
[Function] Returns a positive integer indicating the position of the last occurrence of needle in haystack. Returns 0 if haystack does not contain needle. Returns system-missing if needle is an empty string. [Function] Divides needle into parts, each with length needle len. Searches haystack for the last occurrence of each part, and returns the largest value. Returns 0 if haystack does not contain any part in needle. It is an error if needle len does not evenly divide the length of needle. Returns system-missing if needle is an empty string. [Function] If string is at least length characters in length, returns string unchanged. Otherwise, returns string padded with spaces on the right to length length. Returns an empty string if length is system-missing, negative, or greater than 255. [Function] If string is at least length characters in length, returns string unchanged. Otherwise, returns string padded with padding on the right to length length. Returns an empty string if length is system-missing, negative, or greater than 255, or if padding does not contain exactly one character. [Function] Returns string, after removing trailing spaces. Other types of white space are not removed.
RTRIM (string )
[Function] Returns string, after removing trailing padding characters. If padding does not contain exactly one character, returns an empty string. [Function] Returns a string corresponding to number in the format given by format specifier format. For example, STRING(123.56, F5.1) has the value "123.6".
[Function] Returns a string consisting of the value of string from position start onward. Returns an empty string if start is system-missing, less than 1, or greater than the length of string.
51
[Function] Returns a string consisting of the first count characters from string beginning at position start. Returns an empty string if start or count is system-missing, if start is less than 1 or greater than the number of characters in string, or if count is less than 1. Returns a string shorter than count characters if start + count - 1 is greater than the number of characters in string. Examples: SUBSTR("abcdefg", 3, 2) has value "cd"; SUBSTR("nonsense", 4, 10) has the value "sense". [Function] Returns string, changing lowercase letters to uppercase letters.
UPCASE (string )
TIME.DAYS (ndays )
Returns a time corresponding to ndays days.
[Function]
[Function] Returns a time corresponding to nhours hours, nmins minutes, and nsecs seconds. The arguments may not have mixed signs: if any of them are positive, then none may be negative, and vice versa.
CTIME.DAYS (time )
Results in the number of days and fractional days in time.
[Function]
52
CTIME.HOURS (time )
Results in the number of hours and fractional hours in time.
[Function] [Function]
CTIME.MINUTES (time )
Results in the number of minutes and fractional minutes in time.
CTIME.SECONDS (time )
[Function] Results in the number of seconds and fractional seconds in time. (CTIME.SECONDS does nothing; CTIME.SECONDS(x ) is equivalent to x .)
month
If these functions arguments are out-of-range, they are correctly normalized before conversion to date format. Non-integers are rounded toward zero.
[Function] [Function] Results in a date value corresponding to the midnight before day day of month month of year year. [Function] Results in a date value corresponding to the midnight before the first day of month month of year year. [Function] Results in a date value corresponding to the midnight before the first day of quarter quarter of year year. [Function] Results in a date value corresponding to the midnight before the first day of week week of year year.
53
[Function]
XDATE.DATE (time-or-date )
[Function] For a time, results in the time corresponding to the number of whole days date-ortime includes. For a date, results in the date corresponding to the latest midnight at or before date-or-time ; that is, gives the date that date-or-time is in. [Function] For a time, results in the number of whole hours beyond the number of whole days represented by date-or-time. For a date, results in the hour (as an integer between 0 and 23) corresponding to date-or-time. [Function] Results in the day of the year (as an integer between 1 and 366) corresponding to date. [Function] Results in the day of the month (as an integer between 1 and 31) corresponding to date. [Function] Results in the number of minutes (as an integer between 0 and 59) after the last hour in time-or-date. [Function] Results in the month of the year (as an integer between 1 and 12) corresponding to date. [Function] Results in the quarter of the year (as an integer between 1 and 4) corresponding to date. [Function] Results in the number of whole seconds after the last whole minute (as an integer between 0 and 59) in time-or-date. [Function] Results in the number of whole days from 14 Oct 1582 to date.
XDATE.HOUR (time-or-date )
XDATE.JDAY (date )
XDATE.MDAY (date )
XDATE.MINUTE (time-or-date )
XDATE.MONTH (date )
XDATE.QUARTER (date )
XDATE.SECOND (time-or-date )
XDATE.TDAY (date )
54
XDATE.TIME (date )
[Function] Results in the time of day at the instant corresponding to date, as a time value. This is the number of seconds since midnight on the day corresponding to date. [Function] Results in the week of the year (as an integer between 1 and 53) corresponding to date. [Function] Results in the day of week (as an integer between 1 and 7) corresponding to date, where 1 represents Sunday. [Function] Returns the year (as an integer 1582 or greater) corresponding to date.
XDATE.WEEK (date )
XDATE.WKDAY (date )
XDATE.YEAR (date )
[Function] Returns the span of time from date1 to date2 in terms of unit, which must be a quoted string, one of years, quarters, months, weeks, days, hours, minutes, and seconds. The result is an integer, truncated toward zero. One year is considered to span from a given date to the same month, day, and time of day the next year. Thus, from Jan. 1 of one year to Jan. 1 the next year is considered to be a full year, but Feb. 29 of a leap year to the following Feb. 28 is not. Similarly, one month spans from a given day of the month to the same day of the following month. Thus, there is never a full month from Jan. 31 of a given year to any day in the following February.
[Function] Returns date advanced by the given quantity of the specified unit, which must be one of the strings years, quarters, months, weeks, days, hours, minutes, and seconds. When unit is years, quarters, or months, only the integer part of quantity is considered. Adding one of these units can cause the day of the month to exceed the number of days in the month. In this case, the method comes into play: if it is omitted or specified as closest (as a quoted string), then the resulting day is the
55
last day of the month; otherwise, if it is specified as rollover, then the extra days roll over into the following month. When unit is weeks, days, hours, minutes, or seconds, the quantity is not rounded to an integer and method, if specified, is ignored.
LAG obtains values from the cases that become the new active dataset after a procedure executes. Thus, LAG will not return values from cases dropped by transformations such as SELECT IF, and transformations like COMPUTE that modify data will change the values returned by LAG. These are both the case whether these transformations precede or follow the use of LAG. If LAG is used before TEMPORARY, then the values it returns are those in cases just before TEMPORARY. LAG may not be used after TEMPORARY. If omitted, ncases defaults to 1. Otherwise, ncases must be a small positive constant integer. There is no explicit limit, but use of a large value will increase memory consumption.
[Function] year is a year, either between 0 and 99 or at least 1582. Unlike other pspp date functions, years between 0 and 99 always correspond to 1900 through 1999. month is a month between 1 and 13. day is a day between 0 and 31. A day of 0 refers to the last day of the previous month, and a month of 13 refers to the first month of the next year. year must be in range. year, month, and day must all be integers. YRMODA results in the number of days between 15 Oct 1582 and the date specified, plus one. The date passed to YRMODA must be on or after 15 Oct 1582. 15 Oct 1582 has a value of 1.
VALUELABEL (variable )
[Function] Returns a string matching the label associated with the current value of variable. If the current value of variable has no associated label, then this function returns the empty string. variable may be a numeric or string variable.
56
CDF.dist (x [, param . . . ]) Cumulative distribution function for dist, that is, the probability that a random variate drawn from the distribution is less than x. The domain of x depends dist. The result is a probability. SIG.dist (x [, param . . . ) Tail probability function for dist, that is, the probability that a random variate drawn from the distribution is greater than x. The domain of x depends dist. The result is a probability. Only a few distributions include an /NAME/ function. IDF.dist (p [, param . . . ]) Inverse distribution function for dist, the value of x for which the CDF would yield p. The value of p is a probability. The range depends on dist and is identical to the domain for the corresponding CDF. RV.dist ([param . . . ]) Random variate function for dist. The range depends on the distribution. NPDF.dist (x [, param . . . ]) Noncentral probability density function. The result is the density of the given noncentral distribution at x. The domain of x depends on dist. The range is nonnegative real numbers. Only a few distributions include an /NAME/ function. NCDF.dist (x [, param . . . ]) Noncentral cumulative distribution function for dist, that is, the probability that a random variate drawn from the given noncentral distribution is less than x. The domain of x depends dist. The result is a probability. Only a few distributions include an NCDF function. The individual distributions are described individually below.
PDF.BETA (x ) CDF.BETA (x, a, b ) IDF.BETA (p, a, b ) RV.BETA (a, b ) NPDF.BETA (x, a, b, lambda ) NCDF.BETA (x, a, b, lambda )
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Beta distribution with shape parameters a and b. The noncentral distribution takes an additional parameter lambda. Constraints: a > 0, b > 0, lambda >= 0, 0 <= x <= 1, 0 <= p <= 1. [Function] [Function] Bivariate normal distribution of two standard normal variables with correlation coefficient rho. Two variates x0 and x1 must be provided. Constraints: 0 <= rho <= 1, 0 <= p <= 1.
57
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Cauchy distribution with location parameter a and scale parameter b. Constraints: b > 0, 0 < p < 1. [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Chi-squared distribution with df degrees of freedom. The noncentral distribution takes an additional parameter lambda. Constraints: df > 0, lambda > 0, x >= 0, 0 <= p < 1.
PDF.CHISQ (x, df ) CDF.CHISQ (x, df ) SIG.CHISQ (x, df ) IDF.CHISQ (p, df ) RV.CHISQ (df ) NPDF.CHISQ (x, df, lambda ) NCDF.CHISQ (x, df, lambda )
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Exponential distribution with scale parameter a. The inverse of a represents the rate of decay. Constraints: a > 0, x >= 0, 0 <= p < 1. [Function] [Function] Exponential power distribution with positive scale parameter a and nonnegative power parameter b. Constraints: a > 0, b >= 0, x >= 0, 0 <= p <= 1. This distribution is a pspp extension. [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] F-distribution of two chi-squared deviates with df1 and df2 degrees of freedom. The noncentral distribution takes an additional parameter lambda. Constraints: df1 > 0, df2 > 0, lambda >= 0, x >= 0, 0 <= p < 1. [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Gamma distribution with shape parameter a and scale parameter b. Constraints: a > 0, b > 0, x >= 0, 0 <= p < 1.
PDF.F (x, df1, df2 ) CDF.F (x, df1, df2 ) SIG.F (x, df1, df2 ) IDF.F (p, df1, df2 ) RV.F (df1, df2 ) NPDF.F (x, df1, df2, lambda ) NCDF.F (x, df1, df2, lambda )
58
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Half-normal distribution with location parameter a and shape parameter b. Constraints: b > 0, 0 < p < 1.
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Inverse Gaussian distribution with parameters a and b. Constraints: a > 0, b > 0, x > 0, 0 <= p < 1. [Function] [Function]
PDF.LANDAU (x ) RV.LANDAU ()
Landau distribution.
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Laplace distribution with location parameter a and scale parameter b. Constraints: b > 0, 0 < p < 1.
[Function] Levy symmetric alpha-stable distribution with scale c and exponent alpha. Constraints: 0 < alpha <= 2. [Function] Levy skew alpha-stable distribution with scale c, exponent alpha, and skewness parameter beta. Constraints: 0 < alpha <= 2, -1 <= beta <= 1.
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Logistic distribution with location parameter a and scale parameter b. Constraints: b > 0, 0 < p < 1.
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Lognormal distribution with parameters a and b. Constraints: a > 0, b > 0, x >= 0, 0 <= p < 1. [Function] [Function]
59
[Function] [Function] Normal distribution with mean mu and standard deviation sigma. Constraints: b > 0, 0 < p < 1. Three additional functions are available as shorthand:
CDFNORM (x )
Equivalent to CDF.NORMAL(x, 0, 1).
PROBIT (p )
Equivalent to IDF.NORMAL(p, 0, 1).
NORMAL (sigma )
Equivalent to RV.NORMAL(0, sigma).
[Function] [Function] Normal tail distribution with lower limit a and standard deviation sigma. This distribution is a pspp extension. Constraints: a > 0, x > a, 0 < p < 1. [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Pareto distribution with threshold parameter a and shape parameter b. Constraints: a > 0, b > 0, x >= a, 0 <= p < 1. [Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Rayleigh distribution with scale parameter sigma. This distribution is a pspp extension. Constraints: sigma > 0, x > 0. [Function] [Function] Rayleigh tail distribution with lower limit a and scale parameter sigma. This distribution is a pspp extension. Constraints: a > 0, sigma > 0, x > a.
PDF.RAYLEIGH (x, sigma ) CDF.RAYLEIGH (x, sigma ) IDF.RAYLEIGH (p, sigma ) RV.RAYLEIGH (sigma )
[Function] [Function] Studentized maximum modulus distribution with parameters a and b. Constraints: a > 0, b > 0, x > 0, 0 <= p < 1.
[Function] [Function] Studentized range distribution with parameters a and b. Constraints: a >= 1, b >= 1, x > 0, 0 <= p < 1. [Function] [Function]
60
IDF.T (p, df ) RV.T (df ) NPDF.T (x, df, lambda ) NCDF.T (x, df, lambda )
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] T-distribution with df degrees of freedom. The noncentral distribution takes an additional parameter lambda. Constraints: df > 0, 0 < p < 1.
[Function] [Function] [Function] Type-1 Gumbel distribution with parameters a and b. This distribution is a pspp extension. Constraints: 0 < p < 1. [Function] [Function] [Function] Type-2 Gumbel distribution with parameters a and b. This distribution is a pspp extension. Constraints: x > 0, 0 < p < 1.
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Uniform distribution with parameters a and b. Constraints: a <= x <= b, 0 <= p <= 1. An additional function is available as shorthand: [Function] Equivalent to RV.UNIFORM(0, b).
[Function] [Function] [Function] [Function] Weibull distribution with parameters a and b. Constraints: a > 0, b > 0, x >= 0, 0 <= p < 1.
[Function] [Function] [Function] Bernoulli distribution with probability of success p. Constraints: x = 0 or 1, 0 <= p <= 1.
[Function] [Function] [Function] Binomial distribution with n trials and probability of success p. Constraints: integer n > 0, 0 <= p <= 1, integer x <= n.
61
[Function] [Function] [Function] Geometric distribution with probability of success p. Constraints: 0 <= p <= 1, integer x > 0. [Function] [Function] [Function] Hypergeometric distribution when b objects out of a are drawn and c of the available objects are distinctive. Constraints: integer a > 0, integer b <= a, integer c <= a, integer x >= 0. [Function] [Function] Logarithmic distribution with probability parameter p. Constraints: 0 <= p < 1, x >= 1. [Function] [Function] [Function] Negative binomial distribution with number of successes parameter n and probability of success parameter p. Constraints: integer n >= 0, 0 < p <= 1, integer x >= 1. [Function] [Function] [Function]
62
63
are reserved for pspps internal use, and attribute names that begin with @ or $@ are not displayed by most pspp commands that display other attributes. Other attribute names are not treated specially. Attributes may also be organized into arrays. To assign to an array element, add an integer array index enclosed in square brackets ([ and ]) between the attribute name and value. Array indexes start at 1, not 0. An attribute array that has a single element (number 1) is not distinguished from a non-array attribute. Use the DELETE subcommand to delete an attribute. Specify an attribute name by itself to delete an entire attribute, including all array elements for attribute arrays. Specify an attribute name followed by an array index in square brackets to delete a single element of an attribute array. In the latter case, all the array elements numbered higher than the deleted element are shifted down, filling the vacated position. To associate custom attributes with particular variables, instead of with the entire active dataset, use VARIABLE ATTRIBUTE (see Section 11.14 [VARIABLE ATTRIBUTE], page 103) instead. DATAFILE ATTRIBUTE takes effect immediately. It is not affected by conditional and looping structures such as DO IF or LOOP.
The DATASET commands simplify use of multiple datasets within a pspp session. They allow datasets to be created and destroyed. At any given time, most pspp commands work with a single dataset, called the active dataset. The DATASET NAME command gives the active dataset the specified name, or if it already had a name, it renames it. If another dataset already had the given name, that dataset is deleted. The DATASET ACTIVATE command selects the named dataset, which must already exist, as the active dataset. Before switching the active dataset, any pending transformations are executed, as if EXECUTE had been specified. If the active dataset is unnamed before switching, then it is deleted and becomes unavailable after switching. The DATASET COPY command creates a new dataset with the specified name, whose contents are a copy of the active dataset. Any pending transformations are executed, as if EXECUTE had been specified, before making the copy. If a dataset with the given name already exists, it is replaced. If the name is the name of the active dataset, then the active dataset becomes unnamed. The DATASET DECLARE command creates a new dataset that is initially empty, that is, it has no dictionary or data. If a dataset with the given name already exists, this has no effect. The new dataset can be used with commands that support output to a dataset, e.g. AGGREGATE (see Section 12.1 [AGGREGATE], page 106).
64
The DATASET CLOSE command deletes a dataset. If the active dataset is specified by name, or if * is specified, then the active dataset becomes unnamed. If a different dataset is specified by name, then it is deleted and becomes unavailable. Specifying ALL deletes all datasets except for the active dataset, which becomes unnamed. The DATASET DISPLAY command lists all the currently defined datasets. Many DATASET commands accept an optional WINDOW subcommand. In the psppIRE GUI, the value given for this subcommand influences how the datasets window is displayed. Outside the GUI, the WINDOW subcommand has no effect. The valid values are: ASIS FRONT Do not change how the window is displayed. This is the default for DATASET NAME and DATASET ACTIVATE. Raise the datasets window to the top. Make it the default dataset for running syntax.
MINIMIZED Display the window minimized to an icon. Prefer other datasets for running syntax. This is the default for DATASET COPY and DATASET DECLARE. HIDDEN Hide the datasets window. Prefer other datasets for running syntax.
65
The FILE subcommand must be used if input is to be taken from an external file. It may be used to specify a file name as a string or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). If the FILE subcommand is not used, then input is assumed to be specified within the command file using BEGIN DATA . . . END DATA (see Section 8.1 [BEGIN DATA], page 62). The ENCODING subcommand may only be used if the FILE subcommand is also used. It specifies the character encoding of the file. See Section 16.16 [INSERT], page 150, for information on supported encodings. The optional RECORDS subcommand, which takes a single integer as an argument, is used to specify the number of lines per record. If RECORDS is not specified, then the number of lines per record is calculated from the list of variable specifications later in DATA LIST. The END subcommand is only useful in conjunction with INPUT PROGRAM. See Section 8.9 [INPUT PROGRAM], page 71, for details. The optional SKIP subcommand specifies a number of records to skip at the beginning of an input file. It can be used to skip over a row that contains variable names, for example. DATA LIST can optionally output a table describing how the data file will be read. The TABLE subcommand enables this output, and NOTABLE disables it. The default is to output the table. The list of variables to be read from the data list must come last. Each line in the data record is introduced by a slash (/). Optionally, a line number may follow the slash. Following, any number of variable specifications may be present. Each variable specification consists of a list of variable names followed by a description of their location on the input line. Sets of variables may be specified using the DATA LIST TO convention (see Section 6.7.3 [Sets of Variables], page 32). There are two ways to specify the location of the variable on the line: columnar style and FORTRAN style. In columnar style, the starting column and ending column for the field are specified after the variable name, separated by a dash (-). For instance, the third through fifth columns on a line would be specified 3-5. By default, variables are considered to be in F format (see Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32). (This default can be changed; see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152 for more information.) In columnar style, to use a variable format other than the default, specify the format type in parentheses after the column numbers. For instance, for alphanumeric A format, use (A). In addition, implied decimal places can be specified in parentheses after the column numbers. As an example, suppose that a data file has a field in which the characters 1234 should be interpreted as having the value 12.34. Then this field has two implied decimal places, and the corresponding specification would be (2). If a field that has implied decimal places contains a decimal point, then the implied decimal places are not applied. Changing the variable format and adding implied decimal places can be done together; for instance, (N,5). When using columnar style, the input and output width of each variable is computed from the field width. The field width must be evenly divisible into the number of variables specified. FORTRAN style is an altogether different approach to specifying field locations. With this approach, a list of variable input format specifications, separated by commas, are
66
placed after the variable names inside parentheses. Each format specifier advances as many characters into the input line as it uses. Implied decimal places also exist in FORTRAN style. A format specification with d decimal places also has d implied decimal places. In addition to the standard format specifiers (see Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32), FORTRAN style defines some extensions: X Tx NEWRECx Advance the current column on this line by one character position. Set the current column on this line to column x, with column numbers considered to begin with 1 at the left margin. Skip forward x lines in the current record, resetting the active column to the left margin.
Repeat count Any format specifier may be preceded by a number. This causes the action of that format specifier to be repeated the specified number of times. (spec1, . . . , specN ) Group the given specifiers together. This is most useful when preceded by a repeat count. Groups may be nested arbitrarily. FORTRAN and columnar styles may be freely intermixed. Columnar style leaves the active column immediately after the ending column specified. Record motion using NEWREC in FORTRAN style also applies to later FORTRAN and columnar specifiers.
Examples
1. DATA LIST TABLE /NAME 1-10 (A) INFO1 TO INFO3 12-17 (1). BEGIN DATA. John Smith 102311 Bob Arnold 122015 Bill Yates 918 6 END DATA. Defines the following variables: NAME, a 10-character-wide string variable, in columns 1 through 10. INFO1, a numeric variable, in columns 12 through 13. INFO2, a numeric variable, in columns 14 through 15. INFO3, a numeric variable, in columns 16 through 17. The BEGIN DATA/END DATA commands cause three cases to be defined: Case NAME INFO1 INFO2 INFO3 1 John Smith 10 23 11 2 Bob Arnold 12 20 15 3 Bill Yates 9 18 6 The TABLE keyword causes pspp to print out a table describing the four variables defined.
67
2. DAT LIS FIL="survey.dat" /ID 1-5 NAME 7-36 (A) SURNAME 38-67 (A) MINITIAL 69 (A) /Q01 TO Q50 7-56 /. Defines the following variables: ID, a numeric variable, in columns 1-5 of the first record. NAME, a 30-character string variable, in columns 7-36 of the first record. SURNAME, a 30-character string variable, in columns 38-67 of the first record. MINITIAL, a 1-character string variable, in column 69 of the first record. Fifty variables Q01, Q02, Q03, . . . , Q49, Q50, all numeric, Q01 in column 7, Q02 in column 8, . . . , Q49 in column 55, Q50 in column 56, all in the second record. Cases are separated by a blank record. Data is read from file survey.dat in the current directory. This example shows keywords abbreviated to their first 3 letters.
68
The variables to be parsed are given as a single list of variable names. This list must be introduced by a single slash (/). The set of variable names may contain format specifications in parentheses (see Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32). Format specifications apply to all variables back to the previous parenthesized format specification. In addition, an asterisk may be used to indicate that all variables preceding it are to have input/output format F8.0. Specified field widths are ignored on input, although all normal limits on field width apply, but they are honored on output.
69
FILE HANDLE handle name /NAME=file name /MODE=IMAGE [/LRECL=rec len] [ENCODING=encoding ] For binary files in native encoding with variable-length records: FILE HANDLE handle name /NAME=file name /MODE=BINARY [/LRECL=rec len] [ENCODING=encoding ] For binary files encoded in EBCDIC: FILE HANDLE handle name /NAME=file name /MODE=360 /RECFORM={FIXED,VARIABLE,SPANNED} [/LRECL=rec len] [ENCODING=encoding ] Use FILE HANDLE to associate a file handle name with a file and its attributes, so that later commands can refer to the file by its handle name. Names of text files can be specified directly on commands that access files, so that FILE HANDLE is only needed when a file is not an ordinary file containing lines of text. However, FILE HANDLE may be used even for text files, and it may be easier to specify a files name once and later refer to it by an abstract handle. Specify the file handle name as the identifier immediately following the FILE HANDLE command name. The identifier INLINE is reserved for representing data embedded in the syntax file (see Section 8.1 [BEGIN DATA], page 62) The file handle name must not already have been used in a previous invocation of FILE HANDLE, unless it has been closed by an intervening command (see Section 8.2 [CLOSE FILE HANDLE], page 62). The effect and syntax of FILE HANDLE depends on the selected MODE: In CHARACTER mode, the default, the data file is read as a text file, according to the local systems conventions, and each text line is read as one record. In CHARACTER mode only, tabs are expanded to spaces by input programs, except by DATA LIST FREE with explicitly specified delimiters. Each tab is 4 characters wide by default, but TABWIDTH (a pspp extension) may be used to specify an alternate width. Use a TABWIDTH of 0 to suppress tab expansion. In IMAGE mode, the data file is treated as a series of fixed-length binary records. LRECL should be used to specify the record length in bytes, with a default of 1024. On input, it is an error if an IMAGE files length is not a integer multiple of the record length. On output, each record is padded with spaces or truncated, if necessary, to make it exactly the correct length. In BINARY mode, the data file is treated as a series of variable-length binary records. LRECL may be specified, but its value is ignored. The data for each record is both
70
preceded and followed by a 32-bit signed integer in little-endian byte order that specifies the length of the record. (This redundancy permits records in these files to be efficiently read in reverse order, although pspp always reads them in forward order.) The length does not include either integer. Mode 360 reads and writes files in formats first used for tapes in the 1960s on IBM mainframe operating systems and still supported today by the modern successors of those operating systems. For more information, see OS/400 Tape and Diskette Device Programming, available on IBMs website. Alphanumeric data in mode 360 files are encoded in EBCDIC. pspp translates EBCDIC to or from the hosts native format as necessary on input or output, using an ASCII/EBCDIC translation that is one-to-one, so that a round trip from ASCII to EBCDIC back to ASCII, or vice versa, always yields exactly the original data. The RECFORM subcommand is required in mode 360. The precise file format depends on its setting: F FIXED This record format is equivalent to IMAGE mode, except for EBCDIC translation. IBM documentation calls this *F (fixed-length, deblocked) format.
V VARIABLE The file comprises a sequence of zero or more variable-length blocks. Each block begins with a 4-byte block descriptor word (BDW). The first two bytes of the BDW are an unsigned integer in big-endian byte order that specifies the length of the block, including the BDW itself. The other two bytes of the BDW are ignored on input and written as zeros on output. Following the BDW, the remainder of each block is a sequence of one or more variable-length records, each of which in turn begins with a 4-byte record descriptor word (RDW) that has the same format as the BDW. Following the RDW, the remainder of each record is the record data. The maximum length of a record in VARIABLE mode is 65,527 bytes: 65,535 bytes (the maximum value of a 16-bit unsigned integer), minus 4 bytes for the BDW, minus 4 bytes for the RDW. In mode VARIABLE, LRECL specifies a maximum, not a fixed, record length, in bytes. The default is 8,192. IBM documentation calls this *VB (variable-length, blocked, unspanned) format. VS SPANNED The file format is like that of VARIABLE mode, except that logical records may be split among multiple physical records (called segments ) or blocks. In SPANNED mode, the third byte of each RDW is called the segment control character (SCC). Odd SCC values cause the segment to be appended to a record buffer maintained in memory; even values also append the segment and then flush its contents to the input procedure. Canonically,
71
SCC value 0 designates a record not spanned among multiple segments, and values 1 through 3 designate the first segment, the last segment, or an intermediate segment, respectively, within a multi-segment record. The record buffer is also flushed at end of file regardless of the final records SCC. The maximum length of a logical record in VARIABLE mode is limited only by memory available to pspp. Segments are limited to 65,527 bytes, as in VARIABLE mode. This format is similar to what IBM documentation call *VS (variablelength, deblocked, spanned) format. In mode 360, fields of type A that extend beyond the end of a record read from disk are padded with spaces in the hosts native character set, which are then translated from EBCDIC to the native character set. Thus, when the hosts native character set is based on ASCII, these fields are effectively padded with character X80. This wart is implemented for compatibility. The NAME subcommand specifies the name of the file associated with the handle. It is required in all modes but SCRATCH mode, in which its use is forbidden. The ENCODING subcommand specifies the encoding of text in the file. For reading text files in CHARACTER mode, all of the forms described for ENCODING on the INSERT command are supported (see Section 16.16 [INSERT], page 150). For reading in other filebased modes, encoding autodetection is not supported; if the specified encoding requests autodetection then the default encoding will be used. This is also true when a file handle is used for writing a file in any mode.
72
CASE controls exactly when cases are output. When END CASE is used, looping from the end of INPUT PROGRAM to the beginning does not cause a case to be output. END FILE is the second. When the END subcommand is used on DATA LIST, there is no way for the INPUT PROGRAM construct to stop looping, so an infinite loop results. END FILE, when executed, stops the flow of input data and passes out of the INPUT PROGRAM structure. All this is very confusing. A few examples should help to clarify. INPUT PROGRAM. DATA LIST NOTABLE FILE=a.data/X 1-10. DATA LIST NOTABLE FILE=b.data/Y 1-10. END INPUT PROGRAM. LIST. The example above reads variable X from file a.data and variable Y from file b.data. If one file is shorter than the other then the extra data in the longer file is ignored. INPUT PROGRAM. NUMERIC #A #B. DO IF NOT #A. DATA LIST NOTABLE END=#A FILE=a.data/X 1-10. END IF. DO IF NOT #B. DATA LIST NOTABLE END=#B FILE=b.data/Y 1-10. END IF. DO IF #A AND #B. END FILE. END IF. END CASE. END INPUT PROGRAM. LIST. The above example reads variable X from a.data and variable Y from b.data. If one file is shorter than the other then the missing field is set to the system-missing value alongside the present value for the remaining length of the longer file. INPUT PROGRAM. NUMERIC #A #B. DO IF #A. DATA LIST NOTABLE END=#B FILE=b.data/X 1-10. DO IF #B. END FILE. ELSE. END CASE. END IF. ELSE. DATA LIST NOTABLE END=#A FILE=a.data/X 1-10. DO IF NOT #A. END CASE.
73
END IF. END IF. END INPUT PROGRAM. LIST. The above example reads data from file a.data, then from b.data, and concatenates them into a single active dataset. INPUT PROGRAM. NUMERIC #EOF. LOOP IF NOT #EOF. DATA LIST NOTABLE END=#EOF FILE=a.data/X 1-10. DO IF NOT #EOF. END CASE. END IF. END LOOP. COMPUTE #EOF = 0. LOOP IF NOT #EOF. DATA LIST NOTABLE END=#EOF FILE=b.data/X 1-10. DO IF NOT #EOF. END CASE. END IF. END LOOP. END FILE. END INPUT PROGRAM. LIST. The above example does the same thing as the previous example, in a different way. INPUT PROGRAM. LOOP #I=1 TO 50. COMPUTE X=UNIFORM(10). END CASE. END LOOP. END FILE. END INPUT PROGRAM. LIST/FORMAT=NUMBERED. The above example causes an active dataset to be created consisting of 50 random variates between 0 and 10.
8.10 LIST
LIST /VARIABLES=var list /CASES=FROM start index TO end index BY incr index /FORMAT={UNNUMBERED,NUMBERED} {WRAP,SINGLE} The LIST procedure prints the values of specified variables to the listing file.
74
The VARIABLES subcommand specifies the variables whose values are to be printed. Keyword VARIABLES is optional. If VARIABLES subcommand is not specified then all variables in the active dataset are printed. The CASES subcommand can be used to specify a subset of cases to be printed. Specify FROM and the case number of the first case to print, TO and the case number of the last case to print, and BY and the number of cases to advance between printing cases, or any subset of those settings. If CASES is not specified then all cases are printed. The FORMAT subcommand can be used to change the output format. NUMBERED will print case numbers along with each case; UNNUMBERED, the default, causes the case numbers to be omitted. The WRAP and SINGLE settings are currently not used. Case numbers start from 1. They are counted after all transformations have been considered. LIST attempts to fit all the values on a single line. If needed to make them fit, variable names are displayed vertically. If values cannot fit on a single line, then a multi-line format will be used. LIST is a procedure. It causes the data to be read.
8.12 PRINT
PRINT [OUTFILE=file name ] [RECORDS=n lines ] [{NOTABLE,TABLE}] [ENCODING=encoding ] [/[line no ] arg . . . ] arg takes one of the following forms: string [start-end ] var list start-end [type spec ] var list (fortran spec ) var list * The PRINT transformation writes variable data to the listing file or an output file. PRINT is executed when a procedure causes the data to be read. Follow PRINT by EXECUTE to print variable data without invoking a procedure (see Section 16.11 [EXECUTE], page 149). All PRINT subcommands are optional. If no strings or variables are specified, PRINT outputs a single blank line. The OUTFILE subcommand specifies the file to receive the output. The file may be a file name as a string or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). If OUTFILE is not present then output will be sent to pspps output listing file. When OUTFILE is present, a space is inserted at beginning of each output line, even lines that otherwise would be blank.
75
The ENCODING subcommand may only be used if the OUTFILE subcommand is also used. It specifies the character encoding of the file. See Section 16.16 [INSERT], page 150, for information on supported encodings. The RECORDS subcommand specifies the number of lines to be output. The number of lines may optionally be surrounded by parentheses. TABLE will cause the PRINT command to output a table to the listing file that describes what it will print to the output file. NOTABLE, the default, suppresses this output table. Introduce the strings and variables to be printed with a slash (/). Optionally, the slash may be followed by a number indicating which output line will be specified. In the absence of this line number, the next line number will be specified. Multiple lines may be specified using multiple slashes with the intended output for a line following its respective slash. Literal strings may be printed. Specify the string itself. Optionally the string may be followed by a column number or range of column numbers, specifying the location on the line for the string to be printed. Otherwise, the string will be printed at the current position on the line. Variables to be printed can be specified in the same ways as available for DATA LIST FIXED (see Section 8.5.1 [DATA LIST FIXED], page 64). In addition, a variable list may be followed by an asterisk (*), which indicates that the variables should be printed in their dictionary print formats, separated by spaces. A variable list followed by a slash or the end of command will be interpreted the same way. If a FORTRAN type specification is used to move backwards on the current line, then text is written at that point on the line, the line will be truncated to that length, although additional text being added will again extend the line to that length.
76
output. If additional lines of output are specified, these additional lines are written with a space inserted in the first column, as with PRINT. See Section 8.12 [PRINT], page 74, for more information on syntax and usage.
8.15 REREAD
REREAD [FILE=handle] [COLUMN=column] [ENCODING=encoding ]. The REREAD transformation allows the previous input line in a data file already processed by DATA LIST or another input command to be re-read for further processing. The FILE subcommand, which is optional, is used to specify the file to have its line reread. The file must be specified as the name of a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). If FILE is not specified then the last file specified on DATA LIST will be assumed (last file specified lexically, not in terms of flow-of-control). By default, the line re-read is re-read in its entirety. With the COLUMN subcommand, a prefix of the line can be exempted from re-reading. Specify an expression (see Chapter 7 [Expressions], page 44) evaluating to the first column that should be included in the re-read line. Columns are numbered from 1 at the left margin. The ENCODING subcommand may only be used if the FILE subcommand is also used. It specifies the character encoding of the file. See Section 16.16 [INSERT], page 150, for information on supported encodings. Issuing REREAD multiple times will not back up in the data file. Instead, it will re-read the same line multiple times.
77
/{TABLE,NOTABLE} /DATA=var spec . . . where each var spec takes one of the forms var list start-end [type spec ] var list (fortran spec ) REPEATING DATA parses groups of data repeating in a uniform format, possibly with several groups on a single line. Each group of data corresponds with one case. REPEATING DATA may only be used within an INPUT PROGRAM structure (see Section 8.9 [INPUT PROGRAM], page 71). When used with DATA LIST, it can be used to parse groups of cases that share a subset of variables but differ in their other data. The STARTS subcommand is required. Specify a range of columns, using literal numbers or numeric variable names. This range specifies the columns on the first line that are used to contain groups of data. The ending column is optional. If it is not specified, then the record width of the input file is used. For the inline file (see Section 8.1 [BEGIN DATA], page 62) this is 80 columns; for a file with fixed record widths it is the record width; for other files it is 1024 characters by default. The OCCURS subcommand is required. It must be a number or the name of a numeric variable. Its value is the number of groups present in the current record. The DATA subcommand is required. It must be the last subcommand specified. It is used to specify the data present within each repeating group. Column numbers are specified relative to the beginning of a group at column 1. Data is specified in the same way as with DATA LIST FIXED (see Section 8.5.1 [DATA LIST FIXED], page 64). All other subcommands are optional. FILE specifies the file to read, either a file name as a string or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). If FILE is not present then the default is the last file handle used on DATA LIST (lexically, not in terms of flow of control). By default REPEATING DATA will output a table describing how it will parse the input data. Specifying NOTABLE will disable this behavior; specifying TABLE will explicitly enable it. The LENGTH subcommand specifies the length in characters of each group. If it is not present then length is inferred from the DATA subcommand. LENGTH can be a number or a variable name. Normally all the data groups are expected to be present on a single line. Use the CONTINUED command to indicate that data can be continued onto additional lines. If data on continuation lines starts at the left margin and continues through the entire field width, no column specifications are necessary on CONTINUED. Otherwise, specify the possible range of columns in the same way as on STARTS. When data groups are continued from line to line, it is easy for cases to get out of sync through careless hand editing. The ID subcommand allows a case identifier to be present on each line of repeating data groups. REPEATING DATA will check for the same identifier on each line and report mismatches. Specify the range of columns that the identifier will occupy, followed by an equals sign (=) and the identifier variable name. The variable must already have been declared with NUMERIC or another command.
78
REPEATING DATA should be the last command given within an INPUT PROGRAM. It should not be enclosed within a LOOP structure (see Section 14.4 [LOOP], page 121). Use DATA LIST before, not after, REPEATING DATA.
8.17 WRITE
WRITE OUTFILE=file name RECORDS=n lines {NOTABLE,TABLE} /[line no ] arg . . . arg takes one of the following forms: string [start-end ] var list start-end [type spec ] var list (fortran spec ) var list * WRITE writes text or binary data to an output file. See Section 8.12 [PRINT], page 74, for more information on syntax and usage. PRINT and WRITE differ in only a few ways: WRITE uses write formats by default, whereas PRINT uses print formats. PRINT inserts a space between variables unless a format is explicitly specified, but WRITE never inserts space between variables in output. PRINT inserts a space at the beginning of each line that it writes to an output file (and PRINT EJECT inserts 1 at the beginning of each line that should begin a new page), but WRITE does not. PRINT outputs the system-missing value according to its specified output format, whereas WRITE outputs the system-missing value as a field filled with spaces. Binary formats are an exception.
79
80
9.2 EXPORT
EXPORT /OUTFILE=file name /UNSELECTED={RETAIN,DELETE} /DIGITS=n /DROP=var list /KEEP=var list /RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . /TYPE={COMM,TAPE} /MAP The EXPORT procedure writes the active datasets dictionary and data to a specified portable file. By default, cases excluded with FILTER are written to the file. These can be excluded by specifying DELETE on the UNSELECTED subcommand. Specifying RETAIN makes the default explicit. Portable files express real numbers in base 30. Integers are always expressed to the maximum precision needed to make them exact. Non-integers are, by default, expressed to the machines maximum natural precision (approximately 15 decimal digits on many machines). If many numbers require this many digits, the portable file may significantly increase in size. As an alternative, the DIGITS subcommand may be used to specify the number of decimal digits of precision to write. DIGITS applies only to non-integers. The OUTFILE subcommand, which is the only required subcommand, specifies the portable file to be written as a file name string or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). DROP, KEEP, and RENAME follow the same format as the SAVE procedure (see Section 9.6 [SAVE], page 87). The TYPE subcommand specifies the character set for use in the portable file. Its value is currently not used. The MAP subcommand is currently ignored. EXPORT is a procedure. It causes the active dataset to be read.
9.3 GET
GET /FILE={file name ,file handle } /DROP=var list /KEEP=var list /RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . /ENCODING=encoding GET clears the current dictionary and active dataset and replaces them with the dictionary and data from a specified file. The FILE subcommand is the only required subcommand. Specify the system file or portable file to be read as a string file name or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42).
81
By default, all the variables in a file are read. The DROP subcommand can be used to specify a list of variables that are not to be read. By contrast, the KEEP subcommand can be used to specify variable that are to be read, with all other variables not read. Normally variables in a file retain the names that they were saved under. Use the RENAME subcommand to change these names. Specify, within parentheses, a list of variable names followed by an equals sign (=) and the names that they should be renamed to. Multiple parenthesized groups of variable names can be included on a single RENAME subcommand. Variables names may be swapped using a RENAME subcommand of the form /RENAME=(A B =B A ). Alternate syntax for the RENAME subcommand allows the parentheses to be eliminated. When this is done, only a single variable may be renamed at once. For instance, /RENAME=A =B . This alternate syntax is deprecated. DROP, KEEP, and RENAME are executed in left-to-right order. Each may be present any number of times. GET never modifies a file on disk. Only the active dataset read from the file is affected by these subcommands. pspp tries to automatically detect the encoding of string data in the file. Sometimes, however, this does not work well encoding, especially for files written by old versions of SPSS or pspp. Specify the ENCODING subcommand with an IANA character set name as its string argument to override the default. The ENCODING subcommand is a pspp extension. GET does not cause the data to be read, only the dictionary. The data is read later, when a procedure is executed. Use of GET to read a portable file is a pspp extension.
Each supported file type has additional subcommands, explained in separate sections below.
82
83
be represented in pspp. If a datum cannot be represented a warning will be issued and that datum will be set to SYSMIS. The CONNECT subcommand is mandatory. It is a string specifying the parameters of the database server from which the data should be fetched. The format of the string is given in the postgres manual http://www.postgresql.org/docs/8.0/static/libpq.html#LIBPQ-CONNECT. The SQL subcommand is mandatory. It must be a valid SQL string to retrieve data from the database. The ASSUMEDVARWIDTH subcommand specifies the maximum width of string variables read from the database. If omitted, the default value is determined from the length of the string in the first value read for each variable. The UNENCRYPTED subcommand allows data to be retrieved over an insecure connection. If the connection is not encrypted, and the UNENCRYPTED subcommand is not given, then an error will occur. Whether or not the connection is encrypted depends upon the underlying psql library and the capabilities of the database server. The BSIZE subcommand serves only to optimise the speed of data transfer. It specifies an upper limit on number of cases to fetch from the database at once. The default value is 4096. If your SQL statement fetches a large number of cases but only a small number of variables, then the data transfer may be faster if you increase this value. Conversely, if the number of variables is large, or if the machine on which pspp is running has only a small amount of memory, then a smaller value will be better. The following syntax is an example: GET DATA /TYPE=PSQL /CONNECT=host=example.com port=5432 dbname=product user=fred passwd=xxxx /SQL=select * from manufacturer.
84
By default, cases are read from the input file starting from the first line. To skip lines at the beginning of an input file, set FIRSTCASE to the number of the first line to read: 2 to skip the first line, 3 to skip the first two lines, and so on. IMPORTCASE can be used to limit the number of cases read from the input file. With the default setting, ALL, all cases in the file are read. Specify FIRST max cases to read at most max cases cases from the file. Use PERCENT percent to read only percent percent, approximately, of the cases contained in the file. (The percentage is approximate, because there is no way to accurately count the number of cases in the file without reading the entire file. The number of cases in some kinds of unusual files cannot be estimated; pspp will read all cases in such files.) FIRSTCASE and IMPORTCASE may be used with delimited and fixed-format data. The remaining subcommands, which apply only to one of the two file arrangements, are described below.
85
quote characters ends at the next matching quote. Intervening delimiters become part of the field, instead of terminating it. The ability to specify more than one quote character is a pspp extension. By default, a character specified on QUALIFIER cannot itself be embedded within a field that it quotes, because the quote character always terminates the quoted field. With ESCAPE, however, a doubled quote character within a quoted field inserts a single instance of the quote into the field. For example, if is specified on QUALIFIER, then without ESCAPE ab specifies a pair of fields that contain a and b, but with ESCAPE it specifies a single field that contains ab. ESCAPE is a pspp extension. The DELCASE subcommand controls how data may be broken across lines in the data file. With LINE, the default setting, each line must contain all the data for exactly one case. For additional flexibility, to allow a single case to be split among lines or multiple cases to be contained on a single line, specify VARIABLES n variables, where n variables is the number of variables per case. The VARIABLES subcommand is required and must be the last subcommand. Specify the name of each variable and its input format (see Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32) in the order they should be read from the input file.
Examples
On a Unix-like system, the /etc/passwd file has a format similar to this: root:$1$nyeSP5gD$pDq/:0:0:,,,:/root:/bin/bash blp:$1$BrP/pFg4$g7OG:1000:1000:Ben Pfaff,,,:/home/blp:/bin/bash john:$1$JBuq/Fioq$g4A:1001:1001:John Darrington,,,:/home/john:/bin/bash jhs:$1$D3li4hPL$88X1:1002:1002:Jason Stover,,,:/home/jhs:/bin/csh The following syntax reads a file in the format used by /etc/passwd: GET DATA /TYPE=TXT /FILE=/etc/passwd /DELIMITERS=: /VARIABLES=username A20 password A40 uid F10 gid F10 gecos A40 home A40 shell A40. Consider the following data on used cars: model Civic Civic Civic Accord year 2002 2003 1992 2002 mileage 29883 13415 107000 26613 price 15900 15900 3800 17900 type Si EX n/a EX age 2 1 12 1
The following syntax can be used to read the used car data: GET DATA /TYPE=TXT /FILE=cars.data /DELIMITERS= /FIRSTCASE=2 /VARIABLES=model A8 year F4 mileage F6
86
price F5 type A4 age F2. Consider the following information on animals in a pet store: Pets Name, "Age", "Color", "Date Received", "Price", "Height", "Type" , (Years), , , (Dollars), , "Rover", 4.5, Brown, "12 Feb 2004", 80, 14", "Dog" "Charlie", , Gold, "5 Apr 2007", 12.3, "3""", "Fish" "Molly", 2, Black, "12 Dec 2006", 25, 5", "Cat" "Gilly", , White, "10 Apr 2007", 10, "3""", "Guinea Pig" The following syntax can be used to read the pet store data: GET DATA /TYPE=TXT /FILE=pets.data /DELIMITERS=, /QUALIFIER=" /ESCAPE /FIRSTCASE=3 /VARIABLES=name A10 age F3.1 color A5 received EDATE10 price F5.2 height a5 type a10.
87
from 0 at the left column. Introduce the variables in the second and later lines of a case by a slash followed by the number of the line within the case, e.g. /2 for the second line.
Examples
Consider the following data on used cars: model year mileage price type age Civic 2002 29883 15900 Si 2 Civic 2003 13415 15900 EX 1 Civic 1992 107000 3800 n/a 12 Accord 2002 26613 17900 EX 1 The following syntax can be used to read the used car data: GET DATA /TYPE=TXT /FILE=cars.data /ARRANGEMENT=FIXED /FIRSTCASE=2 /VARIABLES=model 0-7 A year 8-15 F mileage 16-23 F price 24-31 F type 32-40 A age 40-47 F.
9.5 IMPORT
IMPORT /FILE=file name /TYPE={COMM,TAPE} /DROP=var list /KEEP=var list /RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . The IMPORT transformation clears the active dataset dictionary and data and replaces them with a dictionary and data from a system file or portable file. The FILE subcommand, which is the only required subcommand, specifies the portable file to be read as a file name string or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). The TYPE subcommand is currently not used. DROP, KEEP, and RENAME follow the syntax used by GET (see Section 9.3 [GET], page 80). IMPORT does not cause the data to be read; only the dictionary. The data is read later, when a procedure is executed. Use of IMPORT to read a system file is a pspp extension.
9.6 SAVE
SAVE /OUTFILE={file name ,file handle } /UNSELECTED={RETAIN,DELETE} /{COMPRESSED,UNCOMPRESSED} /PERMISSIONS={WRITEABLE,READONLY} /DROP=var list /KEEP=var list
88
/VERSION=version /RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . /NAMES /MAP The SAVE procedure causes the dictionary and data in the active dataset to be written to a system file. OUTFILE is the only required subcommand. Specify the system file to be written as a string file name or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). By default, cases excluded with FILTER are written to the system file. These can be excluded by specifying DELETE on the UNSELECTED subcommand. Specifying RETAIN makes the default explicit. The COMPRESS and UNCOMPRESS subcommand determine whether the saved system file is compressed. By default, system files are compressed. This default can be changed with the SET command (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152). The PERMISSIONS subcommand specifies permissions for the new system file. WRITEABLE, the default, creates the file with read and write permission. READONLY creates the file for read-only access. By default, all the variables in the active dataset dictionary are written to the system file. The DROP subcommand can be used to specify a list of variables not to be written. In contrast, KEEP specifies variables to be written, with all variables not specified not written. Normally variables are saved to a system file under the same names they have in the active dataset. Use the RENAME subcommand to change these names. Specify, within parentheses, a list of variable names followed by an equals sign (=) and the names that they should be renamed to. Multiple parenthesized groups of variable names can be included on a single RENAME subcommand. Variables names may be swapped using a RENAME subcommand of the form /RENAME=(A B =B A ). Alternate syntax for the RENAME subcommand allows the parentheses to be eliminated. When this is done, only a single variable may be renamed at once. For instance, /RENAME=A =B . This alternate syntax is deprecated. DROP, KEEP, and RENAME are performed in left-to-right order. They each may be present any number of times. SAVE never modifies the active dataset. DROP, KEEP, and RENAME only affect the system file written to disk. The VERSION subcommand specifies the version of the file format. Valid versions are 2 and 3. The default version is 3. In version 2 system files, variable names longer than 8 bytes will be truncated. The two versions are otherwise identical. The NAMES and MAP subcommands are currently ignored. SAVE causes the data to be read. It is a procedure.
89
[/DROP=var list] [/KEEP=var list] [/RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . ] [/UNSELECTED={RETAIN,DELETE}] [/MAP] . . . additional subcommands depending on TYPE. . . The SAVE TRANSLATE command is used to save data into various formats understood by other applications. The OUTFILE and TYPE subcommands are mandatory. OUTFILE specifies the file to be written, as a string file name or a file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42). TYPE determines the type of the file or source to read. It must be one of the following: CSV TAB Comma-separated value format, Tab-delimited format.
By default, SAVE TRANSLATE will not overwrite an existing file. Use REPLACE to force an existing file to be overwritten. With MISSING=IGNORE, the default, SAVE TRANSLATE treats user-missing values as if they were not missing. Specify MISSING=RECODE to output numeric user-missing values like system-missing values and string user-missing values as all spaces. By default, all the variables in the active dataset dictionary are saved to the system file, but DROP or KEEP can select a subset of variable to save. The RENAME subcommand can also be used to change the names under which variables are saved. UNSELECTED determines whether cases filtered out by the FILTER command are written to the output file. These subcommands have the same syntax and meaning as on the SAVE command (see Section 9.6 [SAVE], page 87). Each supported file type has additional subcommands, explained in separate sections below. SAVE TRANSLATE causes the data to be read. It is a procedure.
90
[/TEXTOPTIONS DELIMITER=delimiter ] [/TEXTOPTIONS QUALIFIER=qualifier ] [/TEXTOPTIONS DECIMAL={DOT,COMMA}] [/TEXTOPTIONS FORMAT={PLAIN,VARIABLE}] The SAVE TRANSLATE command with TYPE=CSV or TYPE=TAB writes data in a comma- or tab-separated value format similar to that described by RFC 4180. Each variable becomes one output column, and each case becomes one line of output. If FIELDNAMES is specified, an additional line at the top of the output file lists variable names. The CELLS and TEXTOPTIONS FORMAT settings determine how values are written to the output file: CELLS=VALUES FORMAT=PLAIN (the default settings) Writes variables to the output in plain formats that ignore the details of variable formats. Numeric values are written as plain decimal numbers with enough digits to indicate their exact values in machine representation. Numeric values include e followed by an exponent if the exponent value would be less than -4 or greater than 16. Dates are written in MM/DD/YYYY format and times in HH:MM:SS format. WKDAY and MONTH values are written as decimal numbers. Numeric values use, by default, the decimal point character set with SET DECIMAL (see [SET DECIMAL], page 154). Use DECIMAL=DOT or DECIMAL=COMMA to force a particular decimal point character. CELLS=VALUES FORMAT=VARIABLE Writes variables using their print formats. Leading and trailing spaces are removed from numeric values, and trailing spaces are removed from string values. CELLS=LABEL FORMAT=PLAIN CELLS=LABEL FORMAT=VARIABLE Writes value labels where they exist, and otherwise writes the values themselves as described above. Regardless of CELLS and TEXTOPTIONS FORMAT, numeric system-missing values are output as a single space. For TYPE=TAB, tab characters delimit values. For TYPE=CSV, the TEXTOPTIONS DELIMITER and DECIMAL settings determine the character that separate values within a line. If DELIMITER is specified, then the specified string separate values. If DELIMITER is not specified, then the default is a comma with DECIMAL=DOT or a semicolon with DECIMAL=COMMA. If DECIMAL is not given either, it is implied by the decimal point character set with SET DECIMAL (see [SET DECIMAL], page 154). The TEXTOPTIONS QUALIFIER setting specifies a character that is output before and after a value that contains the delimiter character or the qualifier character. The default is a double quote (@). A qualifier character that appears within a value is doubled.
91
Specify a file name or file handle. SYSFILE INFO reads that file as a system file and displays information on its dictionary. SYSFILE INFO does not affect the current active dataset.
9.9 XEXPORT
XEXPORT /OUTFILE=file name /DIGITS=n /DROP=var list /KEEP=var list /RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . /TYPE={COMM,TAPE} /MAP The EXPORT transformation writes the active dataset dictionary and data to a specified portable file. This transformation is a pspp extension. It is similar to the EXPORT procedure, with two differences: XEXPORT is a transformation, not a procedure. It is executed when the data is read by a procedure or procedure-like command. XEXPORT does not support the UNSELECTED subcommand. See Section 9.2 [EXPORT], page 80, for more information.
9.10 XSAVE
XSAVE /OUTFILE=file name /{COMPRESSED,UNCOMPRESSED} /PERMISSIONS={WRITEABLE,READONLY} /DROP=var list /KEEP=var list /VERSION=version /RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . /NAMES /MAP The XSAVE transformation writes the active datasets dictionary and data to a system file. It is similar to the SAVE procedure, with two differences: XSAVE is a transformation, not a procedure. It is executed when the data is read by a procedure or procedure-like command. XSAVE does not support the UNSELECTED subcommand. See Section 9.6 [SAVE], page 87, for more information.
92
93
Each FILE subcommand may be followed by any number of RENAME subcommands that specify a parenthesized group or groups of variable names as they appear in the input file, followed by those variables new names, separated by an equals sign (=), e.g. /RENAME=(OLD1=NEW1)(OLD2=NEW2). To rename a single variable, the parentheses may be omitted: /RENAME=old =new . Within a parenthesized group, variables are renamed simultaneously, so that /RENAME=(A B =B A ) exchanges the names of variables A and B. Otherwise, renaming occurs in left-to-right order. Each FILE subcommand may optionally be followed by a single IN subcommand, which creates a numeric variable with the specified name and format F1.0. The IN variable takes value 1 in an output case if the given input file contributed to that output case, and 0 otherwise. The DROP, KEEP, and RENAME subcommands have no effect on IN variables. If BY is used (see below), the SORT keyword must be specified after a FILE if that input file is not already sorted on the BY variables. When SORT is specified, pspp sorts the input files data on the BY variables before it applies it to the command. When SORT is used, BY is required. SORT is a pspp extension. pspp merges the dictionaries of all of the input files to form the dictionary of the new active dataset, like so: The variables in the new active dataset are the union of all the input files variables, matched based on their name. When a single input file contains a variable with a given name, the output file will contain exactly that variable. When more than one input file contains a variable with a given name, those variables must all have the same type (numeric or string) and, for string variables, the same width. Variables are matched after renaming with the RENAME subcommand. Thus, RENAME can be used to resolve conflicts. The variable label for each output variable is taken from the first specified input file that has a variable label for that variable, and similarly for value labels and missing values. The file label of the new active dataset (see Section 16.12 [FILE LABEL], page 150) is that of the first specified FILE that has a file label. The documents in the new active dataset (see Section 16.5 [DOCUMENT], page 148) are the concatenation of all the input files documents, in the order in which the FILE subcommands are specified. If all of the input files are weighted on the same variable, then the new active dataset is weighted on that variable. Otherwise, the new active dataset is not weighted. The remaining subcommands apply to the output file as a whole, rather than to individual input files. They must be specified at the end of the command specification, following all of the FILE and related subcommands. The most important of these subcommands is BY, which specifies a set of one or more variables that may be used to find corresponding cases in each of the input files. The variables specified on BY must be present in all of the input files. Furthermore, if any of the input files are not sorted on the BY variables, then SORT must be specified for those input files. The variables listed on BY may include (A) or (D) annotations to specify ascending or descending sort order. See Section 12.8 [SORT CASES], page 115, for more details on this notation. Adding (A) or (D) to the BY subcommand specification is a pspp extension.
94
The DROP subcommand can be used to specify a list of variables to exclude from the output. By contrast, the KEEP subcommand can be used to specify variables to include in the output; all variables not listed are dropped. DROP and KEEP are executed in left-to-right order and may be repeated any number of times. DROP and KEEP do not affect variables created by the IN, FIRST, and LAST subcommands, which are always included in the new active dataset, but they can be used to drop BY variables. The FIRST and LAST subcommands are optional. They may only be specified on MATCH FILES and ADD FILES, and only when BY is used. FIRST and LIST each adds a numeric variable to the new active dataset, with the name given as the subcommands argument and F1.0 print and write formats. The value of the FIRST variable is 1 in the first output case with a given set of values for the BY variables, and 0 in other cases. Similarly, the LAST variable is 1 in the last case with a given of BY values, and 0 in other cases. When any of these commands creates an output case, variables that are only in files that are not present for the current case are set to the system-missing value for numeric variables or spaces for string variables.
95
96
10.4 UPDATE
UPDATE Per input file: /FILE={*,file name } [/RENAME=(src names =target names ). . . ] [/IN=var name ] [/SORT] Once per command: /BY var list[({D|A})] [var list[({D|A})]]. . . [/DROP=var list] [/KEEP=var list] [/MAP] UPDATE updates a master file by applying modifications from one or more transaction files. UPDATE shares the bulk of its syntax with other pspp commands for combining multiple data files. See Section 10.1 [Combining Files Common Syntax], page 92, above, for an explanation of this common syntax. At least two FILE subcommands must be specified. The first FILE subcommand names the master file, and the rest name transaction files. Every input file must either be sorted on the variables named on the BY subcommand, or the SORT subcommand must be used just after the FILE subcommand for that input file. UPDATE uses the variables specified on the BY subcommand, which is required, to attempt to match each case in a transaction file with a case in the master file: When a match is found, then the values of the variables present in the transaction file replace those variables values in the new active file. If there are matching cases in more than more transaction file, pspp applies the replacements from the first transaction file, then from the second transaction file, and so on. Similarly, if a single transaction file has cases with duplicate BY values, then those are applied in order to the master file. When a variable in a transaction file has a missing value or when a string variables value is all blanks, that value is never used to update the master file. If a case in the master file has no matching case in any transaction file, then it is copied unchanged to the output. If a case in a transaction file has no matching case in the master file, then it causes a new case to be added to the output, initialized from the values in the transaction file.
97
11 Manipulating variables
The variables in the active dataset dictionary are important. There are several utility functions for examining and adjusting them.
11.3 DISPLAY
DISPLAY DISPLAY DISPLAY DISPLAY DISPLAY DISPLAY DISPLAY DISPLAY DISPLAY [SORTED] [SORTED] [SORTED] [SORTED] [SORTED] [SORTED] [SORTED] [SORTED] [SORTED] NAMES [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. INDEX [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. LABELS [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. VARIABLES [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. DICTIONARY [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. SCRATCH [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. ATTRIBUTES [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. @ATTRIBUTES [[/VARIABLES=]var list]. VECTORS.
DISPLAY displays information about the active dataset. A variety of different forms of information can be requested. The following keywords primarily cause information about variables to be displayed. With these keywords, by default information is displayed about all variable in the active dataset, in the order that variables occur in the active dataset dictionary. The SORTED keyword causes output to be sorted alphabetically by variable name. The VARIABLES subcommand limits output to the specified variables. NAMES INDEX LABELS The variables names are displayed. The variables names are displayed along with a value describing their position within the active dataset dictionary. Variable names, positions, and variable labels are displayed.
98
VARIABLES Variable names, positions, print and write formats, and missing values are displayed. DICTIONARY Variable names, positions, print and write formats, missing values, variable labels, and value labels are displayed. SCRATCH Variable names are displayed, for scratch variables only (see Section 6.7.5 [Scratch Variables], page 41). ATTRIBUTES @ATTRIBUTES Datafile and variable attributes are displayed. The first form of the command omits those attributes whose names begin with @ or $@. In the second for, all datafile and variable attributes are displayed. With the VECTOR keyword, DISPLAY lists all the currently declared vectors. If the SORTED keyword is given, the vectors are listed in alphabetical order; otherwise, they are listed in textual order of definition within the pspp syntax file. For related commands, see Section 16.6 [DISPLAY DOCUMENTS], page 149 and Section 16.7 [DISPLAY FILE LABEL], page 149.
11.4 FORMATS
FORMATS var list (fmt spec ) [var list (fmt spec )]. . . . FORMATS set both print and write formats for the specified variables to the specified format specification. See Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32. Specify a list of variables followed by a format specification in parentheses. The print and write formats of the specified variables will be changed. All of the variables listed together must have the same type and, for string variables, the same width. Additional lists of variables and formats may be included following the first one. FORMATS takes effect immediately. It is not affected by conditional and looping structures such as DO IF or LOOP.
11.5 LEAVE
LEAVE var list. LEAVE prevents the specified variables from being reinitialized whenever a new case is processed. Normally, when a data file is processed, every variable in the active dataset is initialized to the system-missing value or spaces at the beginning of processing for each case. When a variable has been specified on LEAVE, this is not the case. Instead, that variable is initialized to 0 (not system-missing) or spaces for the first case. After that, it retains its value between cases. This becomes useful for counters. For instance, in the example below the variable SUM maintains a running total of the values in the ITEM variable.
99
DATA LIST /ITEM 1-3. COMPUTE SUM=SUM+ITEM. PRINT /ITEM SUM. LEAVE SUM BEGIN DATA. 123 404 555 999 END DATA. Partial output from this example: 123 404 555 999 123.00 527.00 1082.00 2081.00
It is best to use LEAVE command immediately before invoking a procedure command, because the left status of variables is reset by certain transformationsfor instance, COMPUTE and IF. Left status is also reset by all procedure invocations.
100
The MISSING VALUES command takes effect immediately. It is not affected by conditional and looping constructs such as DO IF or LOOP.
11.8 MRSETS
MRSETS /MDGROUP NAME=name VARIABLES=var list VALUE=value [CATEGORYLABELS={VARLABELS,COUNTEDVALUES}] [{LABEL=label ,LABELSOURCE=VARLABEL}] /MCGROUP NAME=name VARIABLES=var list [LABEL=label ] /DELETE NAME={[names ],ALL} /DISPLAY NAME={[names ],ALL}
101
MRSETS creates, modifies, deletes, and displays multiple response sets. A multiple response set is a set of variables that represent multiple responses to a single survey question in one of the two following ways: A multiple dichotomy set is analogous to a survey question with a set of checkboxes. Each variable in the set is treated in a Boolean fashion: one value (the "counted value") means that the box was checked, and any other value means that it was not. A multiple category set represents a survey question where the respondent is instructed to list up to n choices. Each variable represents one of the responses. Any number of subcommands may be specified in any order. The MDGROUP subcommand creates a new multiple dichotomy set or replaces an existing multiple response set. The NAME, VARIABLES, and VALUE specifications are required. The others are optional: NAME specifies the name used in syntax for the new multiple dichotomy set. The name must begin with $; it must otherwise follow the rules for identifiers (see Section 6.1 [Tokens], page 26). VARIABLES specifies the variables that belong to the set. At least two variables must be specified. The variables must be all string or all numeric. VALUE specifies the counted value. If the variables are numeric, the value must be an integer. If the variables are strings, then the value must be a string that is no longer than the shortest of the variables in the set (ignoring trailing spaces). CATEGORYLABELS optionally specifies the source of the labels for each category in the set: VARLABELS, the default, uses variable labels or, for variables without variable labels, variable names. pspp warns if two variables have the same variable label, since these categories cannot be distinguished in output. COUNTEDVALUES instead uses each variables value label for the counted value. pspp warns if two variables have the same value label for the counted value or if one of the variables lacks a value label, since such categories cannot be distinguished in output. LABEL optionally specifies a label for the multiple response set. If neither LABEL nor LABELSOURCE=VARLABEL is specified, the set is unlabeled. LABELSOURCE=VARLABEL draws the multiple response sets label from the first variable label among the variables in the set; if none of the variables has a label, the name of the first variable is used. LABELSOURCE=VARLABEL must be used with CATEGORYLABELS=COUNTEDVALUES. It is mutually exclusive with LABEL. The MCGROUP subcommand creates a new multiple category set or replaces an existing multiple response set. The NAME and VARIABLES specifications are required, and LABEL is optional. Their meanings are as described above in MDGROUP. pspp warns if two variables in the set have different value labels for a single value, since each of the variables in the set should have the same possible categories. The DELETE subcommand deletes multiple response groups. A list of groups may be named within a set of required square brackets, or ALL may be used to delete all groups. The DISPLAY subcommand displays information about defined multiple response sets. Its syntax is the same as the DELETE subcommand.
102
Multiple response sets are saved to and read from system files by, e.g., the SAVE and GET command. Otherwise, multiple response sets are currently used only by third party software.
11.9 NUMERIC
NUMERIC /var list [(fmt spec )]. NUMERIC explicitly declares new numeric variables, optionally setting their output formats. Specify a slash (/), followed by the names of the new numeric variables. If you wish to set their output formats, follow their names by an output format specification in parentheses (see Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32); otherwise, the default is F8.2. Variables created with NUMERIC are initialized to the system-missing value.
103
Before VALUE LABELS is executed, any existing value labels are cleared from the variables specified. Use ADD VALUE LABELS (see Section 11.1 [ADD VALUE LABELS], page 97) to add value labels without clearing those already present.
11.13 STRING
STRING /var list (fmt spec ). STRING creates new string variables for use in transformations. Specify a slash (/), followed by the names of the string variables to create and the desired output format specification in parentheses (see Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32). Variable widths are implicitly derived from the specified output formats. Created variables are initialized to spaces.
104
VARIABLE ATTRIBUTE takes effect immediately. It is not affected by conditional and looping structures such as DO IF or LOOP.
105
[ /var list ( SCALE | NOMINAL | ORDINAL ) ] . . . [ /var list ( SCALE | NOMINAL | ORDINAL ) ] VARIABLE LEVEL sets the measurement level of variables. Currently, this has no effect except for certain third party software.
11.19 VECTOR
Two possible syntaxes: VECTOR vec name =var list. VECTOR vec name list(count [format]). VECTOR allows a group of variables to be accessed as if they were consecutive members of an array with a vector(index) notation. To make a vector out of a set of existing variables, specify a name for the vector followed by an equals sign (=) and the variables to put in the vector. All the variables in the vector must be the same type. String variables in a vector must all have the same width. To make a vector and create variables at the same time, specify one or more vector names followed by a count in parentheses. This will cause variables named vec 1 through vec count to be created as numeric variables. By default, the new variables have print and write format F8.2, but an alternate format may be specified inside the parentheses before or after the count and separated from it by white space or a comma. Variable names including numeric suffixes may not exceed 64 characters in length, and none of the variables may exist prior to VECTOR. Vectors created with VECTOR disappear after any procedure or procedure-like command is executed. The variables contained in the vectors remain, unless they are scratch variables (see Section 6.7.5 [Scratch Variables], page 41). Variables within a vector may be referenced in expressions using vector(index) syntax.
106
12 Data transformations
The pspp procedures examined in this chapter manipulate data and prepare the active dataset for later analyses. They do not produce output, as a rule.
12.1 AGGREGATE
AGGREGATE OUTFILE={*,file name ,file handle } [MODE={REPLACE, ADDVARIABLES}] /PRESORTED /DOCUMENT /MISSING=COLUMNWISE /BREAK=var list /dest var [label ]. . . =agr func (src vars, args . . . ). . . AGGREGATE summarizes groups of cases into single cases. Cases are divided into groups that have the same values for one or more variables called break variables. Several functions are available for summarizing case contents. The OUTFILE subcommand is required and must appear first. Specify a system file or portable file by file name or file handle (see Section 6.9 [File Handles], page 42), or a dataset by its name (see Section 6.7 [Datasets], page 30). The aggregated cases are written to this file. If * is specified, then the aggregated cases replace the active datasets data. Use of OUTFILE to write a portable file is a pspp extension. If OUTFILE=* is given, then the subcommand MODE may also be specified. The mode subcommand has two possible values: ADDVARIABLES or REPLACE. In REPLACE mode, the entire active dataset is replaced by a new dataset which contains just the break variables and the destination varibles. In this mode, the new file will contain as many cases as there are unique combinations of the break variables. In ADDVARIABLES mode, the destination variables will be appended to the existing active dataset. Cases which have identical combinations of values in their break variables, will receive identical values for the destination variables. The number of cases in the active dataset will remain unchanged. Note that if ADDVARIABLES is specified, then the data must be sorted on the break variables. By default, the active dataset will be sorted based on the break variables before aggregation takes place. If the active dataset is already sorted or otherwise grouped in terms of the break variables, specify PRESORTED to save time. PRESORTED is assumed if MODE=ADDVARIABLES is used. Specify DOCUMENT to copy the documents from the active dataset into the aggregate file (see Section 16.5 [DOCUMENT], page 148). Otherwise, the aggregate file will not contain any documents, even if the aggregate file replaces the active dataset. Normally, only a single case (for SD and SD., two cases) need be non-missing in each group for the aggregate variable to be non-missing. Specifying /MISSING=COLUMNWISE inverts this behavior, so that the aggregate variable becomes missing if any aggregated value is missing. If PRESORTED, DOCUMENT, or MISSING are specified, they must appear between OUTFILE and BREAK. At least one break variable must be specified on BREAK, a required subcommand. The values of these variables are used to divide the active dataset into groups to be summarized. In addition, at least one dest var must be specified.
107
One or more sets of aggregation variables must be specified. Each set comprises a list of aggregation variables, an equals sign (=), the name of an aggregation function (see the list below), and a list of source variables in parentheses. Some aggregation functions expect additional arguments following the source variable names. Aggregation variables typically are created with no variable label, value labels, or missing values. Their default print and write formats depend on the aggregation function used, with details given in the table below. A variable label for an aggregation variable may be specified just after the variables name in the aggregation variable list. Each set must have exactly as many source variables as aggregation variables. Each aggregation variable receives the results of applying the specified aggregation function to the corresponding source variable. The MEAN, MEDIAN, SD, and SUM aggregation functions may only be applied to numeric variables. All the rest may be applied to numeric and string variables. The available aggregation functions are as follows: FGT(var_name, value ) Fraction of values greater than the specified constant. The default format is F5.3. FIN(var_name, low, high ) Fraction of values within the specified inclusive range of constants. The default format is F5.3. FLT(var_name, value ) Fraction of values less than the specified constant. The default format is F5.3. FIRST(var_name ) First non-missing value in break group. The aggregation variable receives the complete dictionary information from the source variable. The sort performed by AGGREGATE (and by SORT CASES) is stable, so that the first case with particular values for the break variables before sorting will also be the first case in that break group after sorting. FOUT(var_name, low, high ) Fraction of values strictly outside the specified range of constants. The default format is F5.3. LAST(var_name ) Last non-missing value in break group. The aggregation variable receives the complete dictionary information from the source variable. The sort performed by AGGREGATE (and by SORT CASES) is stable, so that the last case with particular values for the break variables before sorting will also be the last case in that break group after sorting. MAX(var_name ) Maximum value. The aggregation variable receives the complete dictionary information from the source variable. MEAN(var_name ) Arithmetic mean. Limited to numeric values. The default format is F8.2.
108
MEDIAN(var_name ) The median value. Limited to numeric values. The default format is F8.2. MIN(var_name ) Minimum value. The aggregation variable receives the complete dictionary information from the source variable. N(var_name ) Number of non-missing values. The default format is F7.0 if weighting is not enabled, F8.2 if it is (see Section 13.7 [WEIGHT], page 119). N Number of cases aggregated to form this group. The default format is F7.0 if weighting is not enabled, F8.2 if it is (see Section 13.7 [WEIGHT], page 119).
NMISS(var_name ) Number of missing values. The default format is F7.0 if weighting is not enabled, F8.2 if it is (see Section 13.7 [WEIGHT], page 119). NU(var_name ) Number of non-missing values. Each case is considered to have a weight of 1, regardless of the current weighting variable (see Section 13.7 [WEIGHT], page 119). The default format is F7.0. NU Number of cases aggregated to form this group. Each case is considered to have a weight of 1, regardless of the current weighting variable. The default format is F7.0.
NUMISS(var_name ) Number of missing values. Each case is considered to have a weight of 1, regardless of the current weighting variable. The default format is F7.0. PGT(var_name, value ) Percentage between 0 and 100 of values greater than the specified constant. The default format is F5.1. PIN(var_name, low, high ) Percentage of values within the specified inclusive range of constants. The default format is F5.1. PLT(var_name, value ) Percentage of values less than the specified constant. The default format is F5.1. POUT(var_name, low, high ) Percentage of values strictly outside the specified range of constants. The default format is F5.1. SD(var_name ) Standard deviation of the mean. Limited to numeric values. The default format is F8.2. SUM(var_name ) Sum. Limited to numeric values. The default format is F8.2.
109
Aggregation functions compare string values in terms of internal character codes. On most modern computers, this is ASCII or a superset thereof. The aggregation functions listed above exclude all user-missing values from calculations. To include user-missing values, insert a period (.) at the end of the function name. (e.g. SUM.). (Be aware that specifying such a function as the last token on a line will cause the period to be interpreted as the end of the command.) AGGREGATE both ignores and cancels the current SPLIT FILE settings (see Section 13.5 [SPLIT FILE], page 117).
12.2 AUTORECODE
AUTORECODE VARIABLES=src vars INTO dest vars [ /DESCENDING ] [ /PRINT ] [ /GROUP ] [ /BLANK = {VALID, MISSING} ] The AUTORECODE procedure considers the n values that a variable takes on and maps them onto values 1. . . n on a new numeric variable. Subcommand VARIABLES is the only required subcommand and must come first. Specify VARIABLES, an equals sign (=), a list of source variables, INTO, and a list of target variables. There must the same number of source and target variables. The target variables must not already exist. By default, increasing values of a source variable (for a string, this is based on character code comparisons) are recoded to increasing values of its target variable. To cause increasing values of a source variable to be recoded to decreasing values of its target variable (n down to 1), specify DESCENDING. PRINT is currently ignored. The GROUP subcommand is relevant only if more than one variable is to be recoded. It causes a single mapping between source and target values to be used, instead of one map per variable. If /BLANK=MISSING is given, then string variables which contain only whitespace are recoded as SYSMIS. If /BLANK=VALID is given then they will be allocated a value like any other. /BLANK is not relevant to numeric values. /BLANK=VALID is the default. AUTORECODE is a procedure. It causes the data to be read.
12.3 COMPUTE
COMPUTE variable = expression. or COMPUTE vector(index ) = expression. COMPUTE assigns the value of an expression to a target variable. For each case, the expression is evaluated and its value assigned to the target variable. Numeric and string variables may be assigned. When a string expressions width differs from the target variables width, the string result of the expression is truncated or padded with spaces on the right as necessary. The expression and variable types must match.
110
For numeric variables only, the target variable need not already exist. Numeric variables created by COMPUTE are assigned an F8.2 output format. String variables must be declared before they can be used as targets for COMPUTE. The target variable may be specified as an element of a vector (see Section 11.19 [VECTOR], page 105). In this case, an expression index must be specified in parentheses following the vector name. The expression index must evaluate to a numeric value that, after rounding down to the nearest integer, is a valid index for the named vector. Using COMPUTE to assign to a variable specified on LEAVE (see Section 11.5 [LEAVE], page 98) resets the variables left state. Therefore, LEAVE should be specified following COMPUTE, not before. COMPUTE is a transformation. It does not cause the active dataset to be read. When COMPUTE is specified following TEMPORARY (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118), the LAG function may not be used (see [LAG], page 55).
12.4 COUNT
COUNT var name = var . . . (value . . . ). Each value takes one of the following forms: number string num1 THRU num2 MISSING SYSMIS where num1 is a numeric expression or the words LO or LOWEST and num2 is a numeric expression or HI or HIGHEST . COUNT creates or replaces a numeric target variable that counts the occurrence of a criterion value or set of values over one or more test variables for each case. The target variable values are always nonnegative integers. They are never missing. The target variable is assigned an F8.2 output format. See Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32. Any variables, including string variables, may be test variables. User-missing values of test variables are treated just like any other values. They are not treated as system-missing values. User-missing values that are criterion values or inside ranges of criterion values are counted as any other values. However (for numeric variables), keyword MISSING may be used to refer to all system- and user-missing values. COUNT target variables are assigned values in the order specified. In the command COUNT A =A B (1) /B =A B (2)., the following actions occur: The number of occurrences of 1 between A and B is counted. A is assigned this value. The number of occurrences of 1 between B and the new value of A is counted. B is assigned this value.
111
Despite this ordering, all COUNT criterion variables must exist before the procedure is executedthey may not be created as target variables earlier in the command! Break such a command into two separate commands. The examples below may help to clarify. A. Assuming Q0, Q2, . . . , Q9 are numeric variables, the following commands: 1. Count the number of times the value 1 occurs through these variables for each case and assigns the count to variable QCOUNT. 2. Print out the total number of times the value 1 occurs throughout all cases using DESCRIPTIVES. See Section 15.1 [DESCRIPTIVES], page 123, for details. COUNT QCOUNT=Q0 TO Q9(1). DESCRIPTIVES QCOUNT /STATISTICS=SUM. B. Given these same variables, the following commands: 1. Count the number of valid values of these variables for each case and assigns the count to variable QVALID. 2. Multiplies each value of QVALID by 10 to obtain a percentage of valid values, using COMPUTE. See Section 12.3 [COMPUTE], page 109, for details. 3. Print out the percentage of valid values across all cases, using DESCRIPTIVES. See Section 15.1 [DESCRIPTIVES], page 123, for details. COUNT QVALID=Q0 TO Q9 (LO THRU HI). COMPUTE QVALID=QVALID*10. DESCRIPTIVES QVALID /STATISTICS=MEAN.
12.5 FLIP
FLIP /VARIABLES=var list /NEWNAMES=var name. FLIP transposes rows and columns in the active dataset. It causes cases to be swapped with variables, and vice versa. All variables in the transposed active dataset are numeric. String variables take on the system-missing value in the transposed file. N subcommands are required. If specified, the VARIABLES subcommand selects variables to be transformed into cases, and variables not specified are discarded. If the VARIABLES subcommand is omitted, all variables are selected for transposition. The variables specified by NEWNAMES, which must be a string variable, is used to give names to the variables created by FLIP. Only the first 8 characters of the variable are used. If NEWNAMES is not specified then the default is a variable named CASE LBL, if it exists. If it does not then the variables created by FLIP are named VAR000 through VAR999, then VAR1000, VAR1001, and so on. When a NEWNAMES variable is available, the names must be canonicalized before becoming variable names. Invalid characters are replaced by letter V in the first position, or by _ in subsequent positions. If the name thus generated is not unique, then numeric extensions are added, starting with 1, until a unique name is found or there are no remaining possibilities. If the latter occurs then the FLIP operation aborts. The resultant dictionary contains a CASE LBL variable, a string variable of width 8, which stores the names of the variables in the dictionary before the transposition. Vari-
112
ables names longer than 8 characters are truncated. If the active dataset is subsequently transposed using FLIP, this variable can be used to recreate the original variable names. FLIP honors N OF CASES (see Section 13.2 [N OF CASES], page 116). It ignores TEMPORARY (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118), so that temporary transformations become permanent.
12.6 IF
IF condition variable =expression. or IF condition vector(index )=expression. The IF transformation conditionally assigns the value of a target expression to a target variable, based on the truth of a test expression. Specify a boolean-valued expression (see Chapter 7 [Expressions], page 44) to be tested following the IF keyword. This expression is evaluated for each case. If the value is true, then the value of the expression is computed and assigned to the specified variable. If the value is false or missing, nothing is done. Numeric and string variables may be assigned. When a string expressions width differs from the target variables width, the string result of the expression is truncated or padded with spaces on the right as necessary. The expression and variable types must match. The target variable may be specified as an element of a vector (see Section 11.19 [VECTOR], page 105). In this case, a vector index expression must be specified in parentheses following the vector name. The index expression must evaluate to a numeric value that, after rounding down to the nearest integer, is a valid index for the named vector. Using IF to assign to a variable specified on LEAVE (see Section 11.5 [LEAVE], page 98) resets the variables left state. Therefore, LEAVE should be specified following IF, not before. When IF is specified following TEMPORARY (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118), the LAG function may not be used (see [LAG], page 55).
12.7 RECODE
The RECODE command is used to transform existing values into other, user specified values. The general form is: RECODE src vars (src value src value . . . = dest value ) (src value src value . . . = dest value ) (src value src value . . . = dest value ) . . . [INTO dest vars ]. Following the RECODE keyword itself comes src vars which is a list of variables whose values are to be transformed. These variables may be string variables or they may be numeric. However the list must be homogeneous; you may not mix string variables and numeric variables in the same recoding. After the list of source variables, there should be one or more mappings. Each mapping is enclosed in parentheses, and contains the source values and a destination value separated by a single =. The source values are used to specify the values in the dataset which need to
113
change, and the destination value specifies the new value to which they should be changed. Each src value may take one of the following forms: number If the source variables are numeric then src value may be a literal number. string If the source variables are string variables then src value may be a literal string (like all strings, enclosed in single or double quotes). num1 THRU num2 This form is valid only when the source variables are numeric. It specifies all values in the range [num1, num2 ]. Normally you would ensure that num2 is greater than or equal to num1. If num1 however is greater than num2, then the range [num2,num1 ] will be used instead. Open-ended ranges may be specified using LO or LOWEST for num1 or HI or HIGHEST for num2. MISSING The literal keyword MISSING matches both system missing and user missing values. It is valid for both numeric and string variables. SYSMIS The literal keyword SYSMIS matches system missing values. It is valid for both numeric variables only. ELSE The ELSE keyword may be used to match any values which are not matched by any other src value appearing in the command. If this keyword appears, it should be used in the last mapping of the command. After the source variables comes an = and then the dest value. The dest value may take any of the following forms: number A literal numeric value to which the source values should be changed. This implies the destination variable must be numeric. string A literal string value (enclosed in quotation marks) to which the source values should be changed. This implies the destination variable must be a string variable. SYSMIS The keyword SYSMIS changes the value to the system missing value. This implies the destination variable must be numeric. COPY The special keyword COPY means that the source value should not be modified, but copied directly to the destination value. This is meaningful only if INTO dest_vars is specified. Mappings are considered from left to right. Therefore, if a value is matched by a src value from more than one mapping, the first (leftmost) mapping which matches will be considered. Any subsequent matches will be ignored. The clause INTO dest_vars is optional. The behaviour of the command is slightly different depending on whether it appears or not. If INTO dest_vars does not appear, then values will be recoded in place. This means that the recoded values are written back to the source variables from whence the original values came. In this case, the dest value for every mapping must imply a value which has the same type as the src value. For example, if the source value is a string value, it is not permissible for dest value to be SYSMIS or another forms which implies a numeric result. The following example two numeric variables x and y are recoded in place. Zero is recoded to 99, the values 1 to 10 inclusive are unchanged, values 1000 and higher are recoded to the system-missing value and all other values are changed to 999: recode x y (0 = 99)
114
(1 THRU 10 = COPY) (1000 THRU HIGHEST = SYSMIS) (ELSE = 999). If INTO dest_vars is given, then recoded values are written into the variables specified in dest vars, which must therefore contain a list of valid variable names. The number of variables in dest vars must be the same as the number of variables in src vars and the respective order of the variables in dest vars corresponds to the order of src vars. That is to say, recoded values whose original value came from the nth variable in src vars will be placed into the nth variable in dest vars. The source variables will be unchanged. If any mapping implies a string as its destination value, then the respective destination variable must already exist, or have been declared using STRING or another transformation. Numeric variables however will be automatically created if they dont already exist. The following example deals with two source variables, a and b which contain string values. Hence there are two destination variables v1 and v2. Any cases where a or b contain the values apple, pear or pomegranate will result in v1 or v2 being filled with the string fruit whilst cases with tomato, lettuce or carrot will result in vegetable. Any other values will produce the result unknown: string v1 (a20). string v2 (a20). recode a b ("apple" "pear" "pomegranate" = "fruit") ("tomato" "lettuce" "carrot" = "vegetable") (ELSE = "unknown") into v1 v2. There is one very special mapping, not mentioned above. If the source variable is a string variable then a mapping may be specified as (CONVERT). This mapping, if it appears must be the last mapping given and the INTO dest_vars clause must also be given and must not refer to a string variable. CONVERT causes a number specified as a string to be converted to a numeric value. For example it will convert the string "3" into the numeric value 3 (note that it will not convert three into 3). If the string cannot be parsed as a number, then the system-missing value is assigned instead. In the following example, cases where the value of x (a string variable) is the empty string, are recoded to 999 and all others are converted to the numeric equivalent of the input value. The results are placed into the numeric variable y: recode x ("" = 999) (convert) into y. It is possible to specify multiple recodings on a single command. Introduce additional recodings with a slash (/) to separate them from the previous recodings: recode a (2 = 22) (else = 99) /b (1 = 3) into z .
115
Here we have two recodings. The first affects the source variable a and recodes in-place the value 2 into 22 and all other values to 99. The second recoding copies the values of b into the the variable z, changing any instances of 1 into 3.
116
13.1 FILTER
FILTER BY var name. FILTER OFF. FILTER allows a boolean-valued variable to be used to select cases from the data stream for processing. To set up filtering, specify BY and a variable name. Keyword BY is optional but recommended. Cases which have a zero or system- or user-missing value are excluded from analysis, but not deleted from the data stream. Cases with other values are analyzed. To filter based on a different condition, use transformations such as COMPUTE or RECODE to compute a filter variable of the required form, then specify that variable on FILTER. FILTER OFF turns off case filtering. Filtering takes place immediately before cases pass to a procedure for analysis. Only one filter variable may be active at a time. Normally, case filtering continues until it is explicitly turned off with FILTER OFF. However, if FILTER is placed after TEMPORARY, it filters only the next procedure or procedure-like command.
13.2 N OF CASES
N [OF CASES] num of cases [ESTIMATED]. N OF CASES limits the number of cases processed by any procedures that follow it in the command stream. N OF CASES 100, for example, tells pspp to disregard all cases after the first 100. When N OF CASES is specified after TEMPORARY, it affects only the next procedure (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118). Otherwise, cases beyond the limit specified are not processed by any later procedure. If the limit specified on N OF CASES is greater than the number of cases in the active dataset, it has no effect. When N OF CASES is used along with SAMPLE or SELECT IF, the case limit is applied to the cases obtained after sampling or case selection, regardless of how N OF CASES is placed relative to SAMPLE or SELECT IF in the command file. Thus, the commands N OF CASES 100 and SAMPLE .5 will both randomly sample approximately half of the active datasets cases, then select the first 100 of those sampled, regardless of their order in the command file. N OF CASES with the ESTIMATED keyword gives an estimated number of cases before DATA LIST or another command to read in data. ESTIMATED never limits the number of cases processed by procedures. pspp currently does not make use of case count estimates.
117
13.3 SAMPLE
SAMPLE num1 [FROM num2 ]. SAMPLE randomly samples a proportion of the cases in the active file. Unless it follows TEMPORARY, it operates as a transformation, permanently removing cases from the active dataset. The proportion to sample can be expressed as a single number between 0 and 1. If k is the number specified, and N is the number of currently-selected cases in the active dataset, then after SAMPLE k., approximately k *N cases will be selected. The proportion to sample can also be specified in the style SAMPLE m FROM N . With this style, cases are selected as follows: 1. If N is equal to the number of currently-selected cases in the active dataset, exactly m cases will be selected. 2. If N is greater than the number of currently-selected cases in the active dataset, an equivalent proportion of cases will be selected. 3. If N is less than the number of currently-selected cases in the active, exactly m cases will be selected from the first N cases in the active dataset. SAMPLE and SELECT IF are performed in the order specified by the syntax file. SAMPLE is always performed before N OF CASES, regardless of ordering in the syntax file (see Section 13.2 [N OF CASES], page 116). The same values for SAMPLE may result in different samples. To obtain the same sample, use the SET command to set the random number seed to the same value before each SAMPLE. Different samples may still result when the file is processed on systems with differing endianness or floating-point formats. By default, the random number seed is based on the system time.
13.4 SELECT IF
SELECT IF expression. SELECT IF selects cases for analysis based on the value of expression. Cases not selected are permanently eliminated from the active dataset, unless TEMPORARY is in effect (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118). Specify a boolean expression (see Chapter 7 [Expressions], page 44). If the value of the expression is true for a particular case, the case will be analyzed. If the expression has a false or missing value, then the case will be deleted from the data stream. Place SELECT IF as early in the command file as possible. Cases that are deleted early can be processed more efficiently in time and space. When SELECT IF is specified following TEMPORARY (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118), the LAG function may not be used (see [LAG], page 55).
118
SPLIT FILE allows multiple sets of data present in one data file to be analyzed separately using single statistical procedure commands. Specify a list of variable names to analyze multiple sets of data separately. Groups of adjacent cases having the same values for these variables are analyzed by statistical procedure commands as one group. An independent analysis is carried out for each group of cases, and the variable values for the group are printed along with the analysis. When a list of variable names is specified, one of the keywords LAYERED or SEPARATE may also be specified. If provided, either keyword are ignored. Groups are formed only by adjacent cases. To create a split using a variable where like values are not adjacent in the working file, you should first sort the data by that variable (see Section 12.8 [SORT CASES], page 115). Specify OFF to disable SPLIT FILE and resume analysis of the entire active dataset as a single group of data. When SPLIT FILE is specified after TEMPORARY, it affects only the next procedure (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118).
13.6 TEMPORARY
TEMPORARY. TEMPORARY is used to make the effects of transformations following its execution temporary. These transformations will affect only the execution of the next procedure or procedure-like command. Their effects will not be saved to the active dataset. The only specification on TEMPORARY is the command name. TEMPORARY may not appear within a DO IF or LOOP construct. It may appear only once between procedures and procedure-like commands. Scratch variables cannot be used following TEMPORARY. An example may help to clarify: DATA LIST /X 1-2. BEGIN DATA. 2 4 10 15 20 24 END DATA. COMPUTE X=X/2. TEMPORARY. COMPUTE X=X+3. DESCRIPTIVES X. DESCRIPTIVES X.
119
The data read by the first DESCRIPTIVES are 4, 5, 8, 10.5, 13, 15. The data read by the first DESCRIPTIVES are 1, 2, 5, 7.5, 10, 12.
13.7 WEIGHT
WEIGHT BY var name. WEIGHT OFF. WEIGHT assigns cases varying weights, changing the frequency distribution of the active dataset. Execution of WEIGHT is delayed until data have been read. If a variable name is specified, WEIGHT causes the values of that variable to be used as weighting factors for subsequent statistical procedures. Use of keyword BY is optional but recommended. Weighting variables must be numeric. Scratch variables may not be used for weighting (see Section 6.7.5 [Scratch Variables], page 41). When OFF is specified, subsequent statistical procedures will weight all cases equally. A positive integer weighting factor w on a case will yield the same statistical output as would replicating the case w times. A weighting factor of 0 is treated for statistical purposes as if the case did not exist in the input. Weighting values need not be integers, but negative and system-missing values for the weighting variable are interpreted as weighting factors of 0. User-missing values are not treated specially. When WEIGHT is specified after TEMPORARY, it affects only the next procedure (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118). WEIGHT does not cause cases in the active dataset to be replicated in memory.
120
14.1 BREAK
BREAK. BREAK terminates execution of the innermost currently executing LOOP construct. BREAK is allowed only inside LOOP . . . END LOOP. See Section 14.4 [LOOP], page 121, for more details.
14.2 DO IF
DO IF condition. ... [ELSE IF condition. ... ]. . . [ELSE. . . .] END IF. DO IF allows one of several sets of transformations to be executed, depending on userspecified conditions. If the specified boolean expression evaluates as true, then the block of code following DO IF is executed. If it evaluates as missing, then none of the code blocks is executed. If it is false, then the boolean expression on the first ELSE IF, if present, is tested in turn, with the same rules applied. If all expressions evaluate to false, then the ELSE code block is executed, if it is present. When DO IF or ELSE IF is specified following TEMPORARY (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118), the LAG function may not be used (see [LAG], page 55).
14.3 DO REPEAT
DO REPEAT dummy name=expansion. . . . ... END REPEAT [PRINT]. expansion takes one of the following forms: var list num or range. . . string. . . ALL num or range takes one of the following forms: number num1 TO num2
121
DO REPEAT repeats a block of code, textually substituting different variables, numbers, or strings into the block with each repetition. Specify a dummy variable name followed by an equals sign (=) and the list of replacements. Replacements can be a list of existing or new variables, numbers, strings, or ALL to specify all existing variables. When numbers are specified, runs of increasing integers may be indicated as num1 TO num2 , so that 1 TO 5 is short for 1 2 3 4 5. Multiple dummy variables can be specified. Each variable must have the same number of replacements. The code within DO REPEAT is repeated as many times as there are replacements for each variable. The first time, the first value for each dummy variable is substituted; the second time, the second value for each dummy variable is substituted; and so on. Dummy variable substitutions work like macros. They take place anywhere in a line that the dummy variable name occurs. This includes command and subcommand names, so command and subcommand names that appear in the code block should not be used as dummy variable identifiers. Dummy variable substitutions do not occur inside quoted strings, comments, unquoted strings (such as the text on the TITLE or DOCUMENT command), or inside BEGIN DATA . . . END DATA. New variable names used as replacements are not automatically created as variables, but only if used in the code block in a context that would create them, e.g. on a NUMERIC or STRING command or on the left side of a COMPUTE assignment. Any command may appear within DO REPEAT, including nested DO REPEAT commands. If INCLUDE or INSERT appears within DO REPEAT, the substitutions do not apply to the included file. If PRINT is specified on END REPEAT, the commands after substitutions are made are printed to the listing file, prefixed by a plus sign (+).
14.4 LOOP
LOOP [index var =start TO end [BY incr ]] [IF condition]. ... END LOOP [IF condition]. LOOP iterates a group of commands. A number of termination options are offered. Specify index var to make that variable count from one value to another by a particular increment. index var must be a pre-existing numeric variable. start, end, and incr are numeric expressions (see Chapter 7 [Expressions], page 44.) During the first iteration, index var is set to the value of start. During each successive iteration, index var is increased by the value of incr. If end > start, then the loop terminates when index var > end ; otherwise it terminates when index var < end. If incr is not specified then it defaults to +1 or -1 as appropriate. If end > start and incr < 0, or if end < start and incr > 0, then the loop is never executed. index var is nevertheless set to the value of start. Modifying index var within the loop is allowed, but it has no effect on the value of index var in the next iteration.
122
Specify a boolean expression for the condition on LOOP to cause the loop to be executed only if the condition is true. If the condition is false or missing before the loop contents are executed the first time, the loop contents are not executed at all. If index and condition clauses are both present on LOOP, the index variable is always set before the condition is evaluated. Thus, a condition that makes use of the index variable will always see the index value to be used in the next execution of the body. Specify a boolean expression for the condition on END LOOP to cause the loop to terminate if the condition is true after the enclosed code block is executed. The condition is evaluated at the end of the loop, not at the beginning, so that the body of a loop with only a condition on END LOOP will always execute at least once. If neither the index clause nor either condition clause is present, then the loop is executed max loops (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152) times. The default value of max loops is 40. BREAK also terminates LOOP execution (see Section 14.1 [BREAK], page 120). Loop index variables are by default reset to system-missing from one case to another, not left, unless a scratch variable is used as index. When loops are nested, this is usually undesired behavior, which can be corrected with LEAVE (see Section 11.5 [LEAVE], page 98) or by using a scratch variable as the loop index. When LOOP or END LOOP is specified following TEMPORARY (see Section 13.6 [TEMPORARY], page 118), the LAG function may not be used (see [LAG], page 55).
123
15 Statistics
This chapter documents the statistical procedures that pspp supports so far.
15.1 DESCRIPTIVES
DESCRIPTIVES /VARIABLES=var list /MISSING={VARIABLE,LISTWISE} {INCLUDE,NOINCLUDE} /FORMAT={LABELS,NOLABELS} {NOINDEX,INDEX} {LINE,SERIAL} /SAVE /STATISTICS={ALL,MEAN,SEMEAN,STDDEV,VARIANCE,KURTOSIS, SKEWNESS,RANGE,MINIMUM,MAXIMUM,SUM,DEFAULT, SESKEWNESS,SEKURTOSIS} /SORT={NONE,MEAN,SEMEAN,STDDEV,VARIANCE,KURTOSIS,SKEWNESS, RANGE,MINIMUM,MAXIMUM,SUM,SESKEWNESS,SEKURTOSIS,NAME} {A,D} The DESCRIPTIVES procedure reads the active dataset and outputs descriptive statistics requested by the user. In addition, it can optionally compute Z-scores. The VARIABLES subcommand, which is required, specifies the list of variables to be analyzed. Keyword VARIABLES is optional. All other subcommands are optional: The MISSING subcommand determines the handling of missing variables. If INCLUDE is set, then user-missing values are included in the calculations. If NOINCLUDE is set, which is the default, user-missing values are excluded. If VARIABLE is set, then missing values are excluded on a variable by variable basis; if LISTWISE is set, then the entire case is excluded whenever any value in that case has a system-missing or, if INCLUDE is set, user-missing value. The FORMAT subcommand affects the output format. Currently the LABELS/NOLABELS and NOINDEX/INDEX settings are not used. When SERIAL is set, both valid and missing number of cases are listed in the output; when NOSERIAL is set, only valid cases are listed. The SAVE subcommand causes DESCRIPTIVES to calculate Z scores for all the specified variables. The Z scores are saved to new variables. Variable names are generated by trying first the original variable name with Z prepended and truncated to a maximum of 8 characters, then the names ZSC000 through ZSC999, STDZ00 through STDZ09, ZZZZ00 through ZZZZ09, ZQZQ00 through ZQZQ09, in that sequence. In addition, Z score variable names can be specified explicitly on VARIABLES in the variable list by enclosing them in parentheses after each variable. The STATISTICS subcommand specifies the statistics to be displayed: ALL MEAN SEMEAN STDDEV VARIANCE All of the statistics below. Arithmetic mean. Standard error of the mean. Standard deviation. Variance.
124
Kurtosis and standard error of the kurtosis. Skewness and standard error of the skewness. Range. Minimum value. Maximum value. Sum. Mean, standard deviation of the mean, minimum, maximum. Standard error of the kurtosis.
SESKEWNESS Standard error of the skewness. The SORT subcommand specifies how the statistics should be sorted. Most of the possible values should be self-explanatory. NAME causes the statistics to be sorted by name. By default, the statistics are listed in the order that they are specified on the VARIABLES subcommand. The A and D settings request an ascending or descending sort order, respectively.
15.2 FREQUENCIES
FREQUENCIES /VARIABLES=var list /FORMAT={TABLE,NOTABLE,LIMIT(limit)} {AVALUE,DVALUE,AFREQ,DFREQ} /MISSING={EXCLUDE,INCLUDE} /STATISTICS={DEFAULT,MEAN,SEMEAN,MEDIAN,MODE,STDDEV,VARIANCE, KURTOSIS,SKEWNESS,RANGE,MINIMUM,MAXIMUM,SUM, SESKEWNESS,SEKURTOSIS,ALL,NONE} /NTILES=ntiles /PERCENTILES=percent. . . /HISTOGRAM=[MINIMUM(x min)] [MAXIMUM(x max )] [{FREQ[(y max )],PERCENT[(y max )]}] [{NONORMAL,NORMAL}] /PIECHART=[MINIMUM(x min)] [MAXIMUM(x max )] [{FREQ,PERCENT}] [{NOMISSING,MISSING}] (These options are not currently implemented.) /BARCHART=. . . /HBAR=. . . /GROUPED=. . . The FREQUENCIES procedure outputs frequency tables for specified variables. FREQUENCIES can also calculate and display descriptive statistics (including median and mode) and percentiles, FREQUENCIES can also output histograms and pie charts. The VARIABLES subcommand is the only required subcommand. Specify the variables to be analyzed. The FORMAT subcommand controls the output format. It has several possible settings:
125
TABLE, the default, causes a frequency table to be output for every variable specified. NOTABLE prevents them from being output. LIMIT with a numeric argument causes them to be output except when there are more than the specified number of values in the table. Normally frequency tables are sorted in ascending order by value. This is AVALUE. DVALUE tables are sorted in descending order by value. AFREQ and DFREQ tables are sorted in ascending and descending order, respectively, by frequency count. The MISSING subcommand controls the handling of user-missing values. When EXCLUDE, the default, is set, user-missing values are not included in frequency tables or statistics. When INCLUDE is set, user-missing are included. System-missing values are never included in statistics, but are listed in frequency tables. The available STATISTICS are the same as available in DESCRIPTIVES (see Section 15.1 [DESCRIPTIVES], page 123), with the addition of MEDIAN, the datas median value, and MODE, the mode. (If there are multiple modes, the smallest value is reported.) By default, the mean, standard deviation of the mean, minimum, and maximum are reported for each variable. PERCENTILES causes the specified percentiles to be reported. The percentiles should be presented at a list of numbers between 0 and 100 inclusive. The NTILES subcommand causes the percentiles to be reported at the boundaries of the data set divided into the specified number of ranges. For instance, /NTILES=4 would cause quartiles to be reported. The HISTOGRAM subcommand causes the output to include a histogram for each specified numeric variable. The X axis by default ranges from the minimum to the maximum value observed in the data, but the MINIMUM and MAXIMUM keywords can set an explicit range. Specify NORMAL to superimpose a normal curve on the histogram. Histograms are not created for string variables. The PIECHART subcommand adds a pie chart for each variable to the data. Each slice represents one value, with the size of the slice proportional to the values frequency. By default, all non-missing values are given slices. The MINIMUM and MAXIMUM keywords can be used to limit the displayed slices to a given range of values. The MISSING keyword adds slices for missing values. The FREQ and PERCENT options on HISTOGRAM and PIECHART are accepted but not currently honoured.
15.3 EXAMINE
EXAMINE VARIABLES= var1 [var2 ] . . . [varN ] [BY factor1 [BY subfactor1 ] [ factor2 [BY subfactor2 ]] ... [ factor3 [BY subfactor3 ]] ] /STATISTICS={DESCRIPTIVES, EXTREME[(n)], ALL, NONE} /PLOT={BOXPLOT, NPPLOT, HISTOGRAM, SPREADLEVEL[(t)], ALL, NONE} /CINTERVAL p
126
/COMPARE={GROUPS,VARIABLES} /ID=identity variable /{TOTAL,NOTOTAL} /PERCENTILE=[percentiles ]={HAVERAGE, WAVERAGE, ROUND, AEMPIRICAL, EMPIRICAL } /MISSING={LISTWISE, PAIRWISE} [{EXCLUDE, INCLUDE}] [{NOREPORT,REPORT}] The EXAMINE command is used to perform exploratory data analysis. In particular, it is useful for testing how closely a distribution follows a normal distribution, and for finding outliers and extreme values. The VARIABLES subcommand is mandatory. It specifies the dependent variables and optionally variables to use as factors for the analysis. Variables listed before the first BY keyword (if any) are the dependent variables. The dependent variables may optionally be followed by a list of factors which tell pspp how to break down the analysis for each dependent variable. Following the dependent variables, factors may be specified. The factors (if desired) should be preceeded by a single BY keyword. The format for each factor is factorvar [BY subfactorvar ]. Each unique combination of the values of factorvar and subfactorvar divide the dataset into cells. Statistics will be calculated for each cell and for the entire dataset (unless NOTOTAL is given). The STATISTICS subcommand specifies which statistics to show. DESCRIPTIVES will produce a table showing some parametric and non-parametrics statistics. EXTREME produces a table showing the extremities of each cell. A number in parentheses, n determines how many upper and lower extremities to show. The default number is 5. The subcommands TOTAL and NOTOTAL are mutually exclusive. If TOTAL appears, then statistics will be produced for the entire dataset as well as for each cell. If NOTOTAL appears, then statistics will be produced only for the cells (unless no factor variables have been given). These subcommands have no effect if there have been no factor variables specified. The PLOT subcommand specifies which plots are to be produced if any. Available plots are HISTOGRAM, NPPLOT, BOXPLOT and SPREADLEVEL. The first three can be used to visualise how closely each cell conforms to a normal distribution, whilst the spread vs. level plot can be useful to visualise how the variance of differs between factors. Boxplots will also show you the outliers and extreme values. The SPREADLEVEL plot displays the interquartile range versus the median. It takes an optional parameter t, which specifies how the data should be transformed prior to plotting. The given value t is a power to which the data is raised. For example, if t is given as 2, then the data will be squared. Zero, however is a special value. If t is 0 or is omitted, then data will be transformed by taking its natural logarithm instead of raising to the power of t. The COMPARE subcommand is only relevant if producing boxplots, and it is only useful there is more than one dependent variable and at least one factor. If /COMPARE=GROUPS is specified, then one plot per dependent variable is produced, each of which contain boxplots for all the cells. If /COMPARE=VARIABLES is specified, then one plot per cell is produced, each
127
containing one boxplot per dependent variable. If the /COMPARE subcommand is omitted, then pspp behaves as if /COMPARE=GROUPS were given. The ID subcommand is relevant only if /PLOT=BOXPLOT or /STATISTICS=EXTREME has been given. If given, it shoule provide the name of a variable which is to be used to labels extreme values and outliers. Numeric or string variables are permissible. If the ID subcommand is not given, then the casenumber will be used for labelling. The CINTERVAL subcommand specifies the confidence interval to use in calculation of the descriptives command. The default is 95%. The PERCENTILES subcommand specifies which percentiles are to be calculated, and which algorithm to use for calculating them. The default is to calculate the 5, 10, 25, 50, 75, 90, 95 percentiles using the HAVERAGE algorithm. The TOTAL and NOTOTAL subcommands are mutually exclusive. If NOTOTAL is given and factors have been specified in the VARIABLES subcommand, then then statistics for the unfactored dependent variables are produced in addition to the factored variables. If there are no factors specified then TOTAL and NOTOTAL have no effect. The following example will generate descriptive statistics and histograms for two variables score1 and score2. Two factors are given, viz : gender and gender BY culture. Therefore, the descriptives and histograms will be generated for each distinct value of gender and for each distinct combination of the values of gender and race. Since the NOTOTAL keyword is given, statistics and histograms for score1 and score2 covering the whole dataset are not produced. EXAMINE score1 score2 BY gender gender BY culture /STATISTICS = DESCRIPTIVES /PLOT = HISTOGRAM /NOTOTAL. Here is a second example showing how the examine command can be used to find extremities. EXAMINE height weight BY gender /STATISTICS = EXTREME (3) /PLOT = BOXPLOT /COMPARE = GROUPS /ID = name. In this example, we look at the height and weight of a sample of individuals and how they differ between male and female. A table showing the 3 largest and the 3 smallest values of height and weight for each gender, and for the whole dataset will be shown. Boxplots will also be produced. Because /COMPARE = GROUPS was given, boxplots for male and female will be shown in the same graphic, allowing us to easily see the difference between the genders. Since the variable name was specified on the ID subcommand, this will be used to label the extreme values. Warning! If many dependent variables are specified, or if factor variables are specified for which there are many distinct values, then EXAMINE will produce a very large quantity of output.
128
15.4 CORRELATIONS
CORRELATIONS /VARIABLES = var list [ WITH var list ] [ . . . /VARIABLES = var list [ WITH var list ] /VARIABLES = var list [ WITH var list ] ] [ /PRINT={TWOTAIL, ONETAIL} {SIG, NOSIG} ] [ /STATISTICS=DESCRIPTIVES XPROD ALL] [ /MISSING={PAIRWISE, LISTWISE} {INCLUDE, EXCLUDE} ] The CORRELATIONS procedure produces tables of the Pearson correlation coefficient for a set of variables. The significance of the coefficients are also given. At least one VARIABLES subcommand is required. If the WITH keyword is used, then a non-square correlation table will be produced. The variables preceding WITH, will be used as the rows of the table, and the variables following will be the columns of the table. If no WITH subcommand is given, then a square, symmetrical table using all variables is produced. The MISSING subcommand determines the handling of missing variables. If INCLUDE is set, then user-missing values are included in the calculations, but system-missing values are not. If EXCLUDE is set, which is the default, user-missing values are excluded as well as system-missing values. If LISTWISE is set, then the entire case is excluded from analysis whenever any variable specified in any /VARIABLES subcommand contains a missing value. If PAIRWISE is set, then a case is considered missing only if either of the values for the particular coefficient are missing. The default is PAIRWISE. The PRINT subcommand is used to control how the reported significance values are printed. If the TWOTAIL option is used, then a two-tailed test of significance is printed. If the ONETAIL option is given, then a one-tailed test is used. The default is TWOTAIL. If the NOSIG option is specified, then correlation coefficients with significance less than 0.05 are highlighted. If SIG is specified, then no highlighting is performed. This is the default. The STATISTICS subcommand requests additional statistics to be displayed. The keyword DESCRIPTIVES requests that the mean, number of non-missing cases, and the nonbiased estimator of the standard deviation are displayed. These statistics will be displayed in a separated table, for all the variables listed in any /VARIABLES subcommand. The XPROD keyword requests cross-product deviations and covariance estimators to be displayed for each pair of variables. The keyword ALL is the union of DESCRIPTIVES and XPROD.
15.5 CROSSTABS
CROSSTABS /TABLES=var list BY var list [BY var list]. . .
129
/MISSING={TABLE,INCLUDE,REPORT} /WRITE={NONE,CELLS,ALL} /FORMAT={TABLES,NOTABLES} {PIVOT,NOPIVOT} {AVALUE,DVALUE} {NOINDEX,INDEX} {BOX,NOBOX} /CELLS={COUNT,ROW,COLUMN,TOTAL,EXPECTED,RESIDUAL,SRESIDUAL, ASRESIDUAL,ALL,NONE} /STATISTICS={CHISQ,PHI,CC,LAMBDA,UC,BTAU,CTAU,RISK,GAMMA,D, KAPPA,ETA,CORR,ALL,NONE} (Integer mode.) /VARIABLES=var list (low,high). . . The CROSSTABS procedure displays crosstabulation tables requested by the user. It can calculate several statistics for each cell in the crosstabulation tables. In addition, a number of statistics can be calculated for each table itself. The TABLES subcommand is used to specify the tables to be reported. Any number of dimensions is permitted, and any number of variables per dimension is allowed. The TABLES subcommand may be repeated as many times as needed. This is the only required subcommand in general mode. Occasionally, one may want to invoke a special mode called integer mode. Normally, in general mode, pspp automatically determines what values occur in the data. In integer mode, the user specifies the range of values that the data assumes. To invoke this mode, specify the VARIABLES subcommand, giving a range of data values in parentheses for each variable to be used on the TABLES subcommand. Data values inside the range are truncated to the nearest integer, then assigned to that value. If values occur outside this range, they are discarded. When it is present, the VARIABLES subcommand must precede the TABLES subcommand. In general mode, numeric and string variables may be specified on TABLES. In integer mode, only numeric variables are allowed. The MISSING subcommand determines the handling of user-missing values. When set to TABLE, the default, missing values are dropped on a table by table basis. When set to INCLUDE, user-missing values are included in tables and statistics. When set to REPORT, which is allowed only in integer mode, user-missing values are included in tables but marked with an M (for missing) and excluded from statistical calculations. Currently the WRITE subcommand is ignored. The FORMAT subcommand controls the characteristics of the crosstabulation tables to be displayed. It has a number of possible settings: TABLES, the default, causes crosstabulation tables to be output. NOTABLES suppresses them. PIVOT, the default, causes each TABLES subcommand to be displayed in a pivot table format. NOPIVOT causes the old-style crosstabulation format to be used. AVALUE, the default, causes values to be sorted in ascending order. DVALUE asserts a descending sort order.
130
INDEX and NOINDEX are currently ignored. BOX and NOBOX is currently ignored. The CELLS subcommand controls the contents of each cell in the displayed crosstabulation table. The possible settings are: COUNT ROW Frequency count. Row percent.
EXPECTED Expected value. RESIDUAL Residual. SRESIDUAL Standardized residual. ASRESIDUAL Adjusted standardized residual. ALL NONE All of the above. Suppress cells entirely.
/CELLS without any settings specified requests COUNT, ROW, COLUMN, and TOTAL. If CELLS is not specified at all then only COUNT will be selected. The STATISTICS subcommand selects statistics for computation: CHISQ Pearson chi-square, likelihood ratio, Fishers exact test, continuity correction, linear-by-linear association. PHI CC Phi. Contingency coefficient.
LAMBDA Lambda. UC BTAU CTAU RISK GAMMA D KAPPA ETA Uncertainty coefficient. Tau-b. Tau-c. Risk estimate. Gamma. Somers D. Cohens Kappa. Eta.
131
Selected statistics are only calculated when appropriate for the statistic. Certain statistics require tables of a particular size, and some statistics are calculated only in integer mode. /STATISTICS without any settings selects CHISQ. If the STATISTICS subcommand is not given, no statistics are calculated. Please note: Currently the implementation of CROSSTABS has the followings bugs: Pearsons R (but not Spearman) is off a little. T values for Spearmans R and Pearsons R are wrong. Significance of symmetric and directional measures is not calculated. Asymmetric ASEs and T values for lambda are wrong. ASE of Goodman and Kruskals tau is not calculated. ASE of symmetric somers d is wrong. Approximate T of uncertainty coefficient is wrong. Fixes for any of these deficiencies would be welcomed.
15.6 FACTOR
FACTOR VARIABLES=var list [ /METHOD = {CORRELATION, COVARIANCE} ] [ /EXTRACTION={PC, PAF}] [ /ROTATION={VARIMAX, EQUAMAX, QUARTIMAX, NOROTATE}] [ /PRINT=[INITIAL] [EXTRACTION] [ROTATION] [UNIVARIATE] [CORRELATION] [COVARIANCE] [DET] [KMO] [SIG] [ALL] [DEFAULT] ] [ /PLOT=[EIGEN] ] [ /FORMAT=[SORT] [BLANK(n)] [DEFAULT] ] [ /CRITERIA=[FACTORS(n)] [MINEIGEN(l )] [ITERATE(m)] [ECONVERGE (delta)] [DEFAULT] ] [ /MISSING=[{LISTWISE, PAIRWISE}] [{INCLUDE, EXCLUDE}] ] The FACTOR command performs Factor Analysis or Principal Axis Factoring on a dataset. It may be used to find common factors in the data or for data reduction purposes. The VARIABLES subcommand is required. It lists the variables which are to partake in the analysis.
132
The /EXTRACTION subcommand is used to specify the way in which factors (components) are extracted from the data. If PC is specified, then Principal Components Analysis is used. If PAF is specified, then Principal Axis Factoring is used. By default Principal Components Analysis will be used. The /ROTATION subcommand is used to specify the method by which the extracted solution will be rotated. Three methods are available: VARIMAX (which is the default), EQUAMAX, and QUARTIMAX. If dont want any rotation to be performed, the word NOROTATE will prevent the command from performing any rotation on the data. Oblique rotations are not supported. The /METHOD subcommand should be used to determine whether the covariance matrix or the correlation matrix of the data is to be analysed. By default, the correlation matrix is analysed. The /PRINT subcommand may be used to select which features of the analysis are reported: UNIVARIATE A table of mean values, standard deviations and total weights are printed. INITIAL Initial communalities and eigenvalues are printed. EXTRACTION Extracted communalities and eigenvalues are printed. ROTATION Rotated communalities and eigenvalues are printed. CORRELATION The correlation matrix is printed. COVARIANCE The covariance matrix is printed. DET The determinant of the correlation or covariance matrix is printed. KMO The Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin measure of sampling adequacy and the Bartlett test of sphericity is printed. SIG The significance of the elements of correlation matrix is printed. ALL All of the above are printed. DEFAULT Identical to INITIAL and EXTRACTION. If /PLOT=EIGEN is given, then a Scree plot of the eigenvalues will be printed. This can be useful for visualizing which factors (components) should be retained. The /FORMAT subcommand determined how data are to be displayed in loading matrices. If SORT is specified, then the variables are sorted in descending order of significance. If BLANK(n ) is specified, then coefficients whose absolute value is less than n will not be printed. If the keyword DEFAULT is given, or if no /FORMAT subcommand is given, then no sorting is performed, and all coefficients will be printed. The /CRITERIA subcommand is used to specify how the number of extracted factors (components) are chosen. If FACTORS(n ) is specified, where n is an integer, then n factors will be extracted. Otherwise, the MINEIGEN setting will be used. MINEIGEN(l ) requests that all factors whose eigenvalues are greater than or equal to l are extracted. The default value of l is 1. The ECONVERGE and ITERATE settings have effect only when iterative algorithms for factor extraction (such as Principal Axis Factoring) are used. ECONVERGE(delta ) specifies that iteration should cease when the maximum absolute value of the communality estimate between one iteration and the previous is less than delta. The default value of delta is 0.001. The ITERATE(m ) setting sets the maximum number of iterations to m. The default value of m is 25.
133
The MISSING subcommand determines the handling of missing variables. If INCLUDE is set, then user-missing values are included in the calculations, but system-missing values are not. If EXCLUDE is set, which is the default, user-missing values are excluded as well as system-missing values. This is the default. If LISTWISE is set, then the entire case is excluded from analysis whenever any variable specified in the VARIABLES subcommand contains a missing value. If PAIRWISE is set, then a case is considered missing only if either of the values for the particular coefficient are missing. The default is LISTWISE.
134
The differential of the estimated probability for all cases is less than min epsilon. In other words, the probabilities are close to zero or one. The default value of min epsilon is 0.00000001. The PRINT subcommand controls the display of optional statistics. Currently there is one such option, CI, which indicates that the confidence interval of the odds ratio should be displayed as well as its value. CI should be followed by an integer in parentheses, to indicate the confidence level of the desired confidence interval. The MISSING subcommand determines the handling of missing variables. If INCLUDE is set, then user-missing values are included in the calculations, but system-missing values are not. If EXCLUDE is set, which is the default, user-missing values are excluded as well as system-missing values. This is the default.
15.8 MEANS
MEANS [TABLES =] {var list} [ BY {var list} [BY {var list} [BY {var list} . . . ]]] [ /{var list} [ BY {var list} [BY {var list} [BY {var list} . . . ]]] ] [/CELLS = [MEAN] [COUNT] [STDDEV] [SEMEAN] [SUM] [MIN] [MAX] [RANGE] [VARIANCE] [KURT] [SEKURT] [SKEW] [SESKEW] [FIRST] [LAST] [HARMONIC] [GEOMETRIC] [DEFAULT] [ALL] [NONE] ] [/MISSING = [TABLE] [INCLUDE] [DEPENDENT]] You can use the MEANS command to calculate the arithmetic mean and similar statistics, either for the dataset as a whole or for categories of data. The simplest form of the command is MEANS v. which calculates the mean, count and standard deviation for v. If you specify a grouping variable, for example MEANS v BY g. then the means, counts and standard deviations for v after having been grouped by g will be calculated. Instead of the mean, count and standard deviation, you could specify the statistics in which you are interested: MEANS x y BY g /CELLS = HARMONIC SUM MIN. This example calculates the harmonic mean, the sum and the minimum values of x and y grouped by g.
135
The CELLS subcommand specifies which statistics to calculate. The available statistics are: MEAN The arithmetic mean. COUNT The count of the values. STDDEV The standard deviation. SEMEAN The standard error of the mean. SUM The sum of the values. MIN The minimum value. MAX The maximum value. RANGE The difference between the maximum and minimum values. VARIANCE The variance. FIRST The first value in the category. LAST The last value in the category. SKEW The skewness. SESKEW The standard error of the skewness. KURT The kurtosis SEKURT The standard error of the kurtosis. HARMONIC The harmonic mean. GEOMETRIC The geometric mean. In addition, three special keywords are recognized: DEFAULT This is the same as MEAN COUNT STDDEV. ALL All of the above statistics will be calculated. NONE No statistics will be calculated (only a summary will be shown). More than one table can be specified in a single command. Each table is separated by a /. For example MEANS TABLES = c d e BY x /a b BY x y /f BY y BY z. has three tables (the TABLE = is optional). The first table has three dependent variables c, d and e and a single categorical variable x. The second table has two dependent variables a and b, and two categorical variables x and y. The third table has a single dependent variables f and a categorical variable formed by the combination of y and z. By default values are omitted from the analysis only if missing values (either system missing or user missing) for any of the variables directly involved in their calculation are encountered. This behaviour can be modified with the /MISSING subcommand. Three options are possible: TABLE, INCLUDE and DEPENDENT. /MISSING = TABLE causes cases to be dropped if any variable is missing in the table specification currently being processed, regardless of whether it is needed to calculate the statistic.
136
/MISSING = INCLUDE says that user missing values, either in the dependent variables or in the categorical variables should be taken at their face value, and not excluded. /MISSING = DEPENDENT says that user missing values, in the dependent variables should be taken at their face value, however cases which have user missing values for the categorical variables should be omitted from the calculation.
137
If the test proportion is equal to 0.5, then a two tailed test is reported. For any other test proportion, a one tailed test is reported. For one tailed tests, if the test proportion is less than or equal to the observed proportion, then the significance of observing the observed proportion or more is reported. If the test proportion is more than the observed proportion, then the significance of observing the observed proportion or less is reported. That is to say, the test is always performed in the observed direction. pspp uses a very precise approximation to the gamma function to compute the binomial significance. Thus, exact results are reported even for very large sample sizes.
138
139
The value of the Mann-Whitney U statistic, the Wilcoxon W, and the significance will be printed. The abbreviated subcommand M-W may be used in place of MANN-WHITNEY.
140
number of variables preceding WITH must be the same as the number following it. In this case, tests for each respective pair of variables are performed. If the WITH keyword is given, but the (PAIRED) keyword is omitted, then tests for each combination of variable preceding WITH against variable following WITH are performed.
15.10 T-TEST
T-TEST /MISSING={ANALYSIS,LISTWISE} {EXCLUDE,INCLUDE} /CRITERIA=CIN(confidence )
(Paired Samples mode.) PAIRS=var list [WITH var list [(PAIRED)] ] The T-TEST procedure outputs tables used in testing hypotheses about means. It operates in one of three modes: One Sample mode. Independent Groups mode. Paired mode. Each of these modes are described in more detail below. There are two optional subcommands which are common to all modes. The /CRITERIA subcommand tells pspp the confidence interval used in the tests. The default value is 0.95.
141
The MISSING subcommand determines the handling of missing variables. If INCLUDE is set, then user-missing values are included in the calculations, but system-missing values are not. If EXCLUDE is set, which is the default, user-missing values are excluded as well as system-missing values. This is the default. If LISTWISE is set, then the entire case is excluded from analysis whenever any variable specified in the /VARIABLES, /PAIRS or /GROUPS subcommands contains a missing value. If ANALYSIS is set, then missing values are excluded only in the analysis for which they would be needed. This is the default.
15.11 ONEWAY
ONEWAY [/VARIABLES = ] var list BY var /MISSING={ANALYSIS,LISTWISE} {EXCLUDE,INCLUDE}
142
/CONTRAST= value1 [, value2 ] ... [,valueN ] /STATISTICS={DESCRIPTIVES,HOMOGENEITY} /POSTHOC={BONFERRONI, GH, LSD, SCHEFFE, SIDAK, TUKEY, ALPHA ([value ])} The ONEWAY procedure performs a one-way analysis of variance of variables factored by a single independent variable. It is used to compare the means of a population divided into more than two groups. The dependent variables to be analysed should be given in the VARIABLES subcommand. The list of variables must be followed by the BY keyword and the name of the independent (or factor) variable. You can use the STATISTICS subcommand to tell pspp to display ancilliary information. The options accepted are: DESCRIPTIVES Displays descriptive statistics about the groups factored by the independent variable. HOMOGENEITY Displays the Levene test of Homogeneity of Variance for the variables and their groups. The CONTRAST subcommand is used when you anticipate certain differences between the groups. The subcommand must be followed by a list of numerals which are the coefficients of the groups to be tested. The number of coefficients must correspond to the number of distinct groups (or values of the independent variable). If the total sum of the coefficients are not zero, then pspp will display a warning, but will proceed with the analysis. The CONTRAST subcommand may be given up to 10 times in order to specify different contrast tests. The MISSING subcommand defines how missing values are handled. If LISTWISE is specified then cases which have missing values for the independent variable or any dependent variable will be ignored. If ANALYSIS is specified, then cases will be ignored if the independent variable is missing or if the dependent variable currently being analysed is missing. The default is ANALYSIS. A setting of EXCLUDE means that variables whose values are user-missing are to be excluded from the analysis. A setting of INCLUDE means they are to be included. The default is EXCLUDE. Using the POSTHOC subcommand you can perform multiple pairwise comparisons on the data. The following comparison methods are available: LSD Least Significant Difference. TUKEY Tukey Honestly Significant Difference. BONFERRONI Bonferroni test. SCHEFFE Scheff es test. SIDAK Sidak test. GH The Games-Howell test. The optional syntax ALPHA(value ) is used to indicate that value should be used as the confidence level for which the posthoc tests will be performed. The default is 0.05.
143
[/MISSING={EXCLUDE,INCLUDE} {LISTWISE, PAIRWISE}] The QUICK CLUSTER command performs k-means clustering on the dataset. This is useful when you wish to allocate cases into clusters of similar values and you already know the number of clusters. The minimum specification is QUICK CLUSTER followed by the names of the variables which contain the cluster data. Normally you will also want to specify /CRITERIA=CLUSTERS(k ) where k is the number of clusters. If this is not given, then k defaults to 2. The command uses an iterative algorithm to determine the clusters for each case. It will continue iterating until convergence, or until max iter iterations have been done. The default value of max iter is 2. The MISSING subcommand determines the handling of missing variables. If INCLUDE is set, then user-missing values are considered at their face value and not as missing values. If EXCLUDE is set, which is the default, user-missing values are excluded as well as systemmissing values. If LISTWISE is set, then the entire case is excluded from the analysis whenever any of the clustering variables contains a missing value. If PAIRWISE is set, then a case is considered missing only if all the clustering variables contain missing values. Otherwise it is clustered on the basis of the non-missing values. The default is LISTWISE.
15.13 RANK
RANK [VARIABLES=] var list [{A,D}] [BY var list] /TIES={MEAN,LOW,HIGH,CONDENSE} /FRACTION={BLOM,TUKEY,VW,RANKIT} /PRINT[={YES,NO} /MISSING={EXCLUDE,INCLUDE} /RANK [INTO var list] /NTILES(k) [INTO var list] /NORMAL [INTO var list] /PERCENT [INTO var list] /RFRACTION [INTO var list] /PROPORTION [INTO var list] /N [INTO var list] /SAVAGE [INTO var list] The RANK command ranks variables and stores the results into new variables. The VARIABLES subcommand, which is mandatory, specifies one or more variables whose values are to be ranked. After each variable, A or D may appear, indicating that the variable is to be ranked in ascending or descending order. Ascending is the default. If a BY keyword appears, it should be followed by a list of variables which are to serve as group variables. In this case, the cases are gathered into groups, and ranks calculated for each group. The TIES subcommand specifies how tied values are to be treated. The default is to take the mean value of all the tied cases.
144
The FRACTION subcommand specifies how proportional ranks are to be calculated. This only has any effect if NORMAL or PROPORTIONAL rank functions are requested. The PRINT subcommand may be used to specify that a summary of the rank variables created should appear in the output. The function subcommands are RANK, NTILES, NORMAL, PERCENT, RFRACTION, PROPORTION and SAVAGE. Any number of function subcommands may appear. If none are given, then the default is RANK. The NTILES subcommand must take an integer specifying the number of partitions into which values should be ranked. Each subcommand may be followed by the INTO keyword and a list of variables which are the variables to be created and receive the rank scores. There may be as many variables specified as there are variables named on the VARIABLES subcommand. If fewer are specified, then the variable names are automatically created. The MISSING subcommand determines how user missing values are to be treated. A setting of EXCLUDE means that variables whose values are user-missing are to be excluded from the rank scores. A setting of INCLUDE means they are to be included. The default is EXCLUDE.
15.14 REGRESSION
The REGRESSION procedure fits linear models to data via least-squares estimation. The procedure is appropriate for data which satisfy those assumptions typical in linear regression: The data set contains n observations of a dependent variable, say Y1 , . . . , Yn , and n observations of one or more explanatory variables. Let X11 , X12 , . . . , X1n denote the n observations of the first explanatory variable; X21 ,. . . ,X2n denote the n observations of the second explanatory variable; Xk1 ,. . . ,Xkn denote the n observations of the k th explanatory variable. The dependent variable Y has the following relationship to the explanatory variables: Yi = b0 + b1 X1i + ... + bk Xki + Zi where b0 , b1 , . . . , bk are unknown coefficients, and Z1 , . . . , Zn are independent, normally distributed noise terms with mean zero and common variance. The noise, or error terms are unobserved. This relationship is called the linear model. The REGRESSION procedure estimates the coefficients b0 , . . . , bk and produces output relevant to inferences for the linear model.
15.14.1 Syntax
REGRESSION /VARIABLES=var list /DEPENDENT=var list /STATISTICS={ALL, DEFAULTS, R, COEFF, ANOVA, BCOV} /SAVE={PRED, RESID} The REGRESSION procedure reads the active dataset and outputs statistics relevant to the linear model specified by the user. The VARIABLES subcommand, which is required, specifies the list of variables to be analyzed. Keyword VARIABLES is required. The DEPENDENT subcommand specifies the dependent variable of the linear model. The DEPENDENT subcommand is required. All variables
145
listed in the VARIABLES subcommand, but not listed in the DEPENDENT subcommand, are treated as explanatory variables in the linear model. All other subcommands are optional: The STATISTICS subcommand specifies the statistics to be displayed: ALL R COEFF ANOVA BCOV All of the statistics below. The ratio of the sums of squares due to the model to the total sums of squares for the dependent variable. A table containing the estimated model coefficients and their standard errors. Analysis of variance table for the model. The covariance matrix for the estimated model coefficients.
The SAVE subcommand causes pspp to save the residuals or predicted values from the fitted model to the active dataset. pspp will store the residuals in a variable called RES1 if no such variable exists, RES2 if RES1 already exists, RES3 if RES1 and RES2 already exist, etc. It will choose the name of the variable for the predicted values similarly, but with PRED as a prefix.
15.14.2 Examples
The following pspp syntax will generate the default output and save the predicted values and residuals to the active dataset. title Demonstrate REGRESSION procedure. data list / v0 1-2 (A) v1 v2 3-22 (10). begin data. b 7.735648 -23.97588 b 6.142625 -19.63854 a 7.651430 -25.26557 c 6.125125 -16.57090 a 8.245789 -25.80001 c 6.031540 -17.56743 a 9.832291 -28.35977 c 5.343832 -16.79548 a 8.838262 -29.25689 b 6.200189 -18.58219 end data. list. regression /variables=v0 v1 v2 /statistics defaults /dependent=v2 /save pred resid /method=enter.
15.15 RELIABILITY
RELIABILITY /VARIABLES=var list /SCALE (name ) = {var list, ALL} /MODEL={ALPHA, SPLIT[(n)]} /SUMMARY={TOTAL,ALL}
146
/MISSING={EXCLUDE,INCLUDE} The RELIABILTY command performs reliability analysis on the data. The VARIABLES subcommand is required. It determines the set of variables upon which analysis is to be performed. The SCALE subcommand determines which variables reliability is to be calculated for. If it is omitted, then analysis for all variables named in the VARIABLES subcommand will be used. Optionally, the name parameter may be specified to set a string name for the scale. The MODEL subcommand determines the type of analysis. If ALPHA is specified, then Cronbachs Alpha is calculated for the scale. If the model is SPLIT, then the variables are divided into 2 subsets. An optional parameter n may be given, to specify how many variables to be in the first subset. If n is omitted, then it defaults to one half of the variables in the scale, or one half minus one if there are an odd number of variables. The default model is ALPHA. By default, any cases with user missing, or system missing values for any variables given in the VARIABLES subcommand will be omitted from analysis. The MISSING subcommand determines whether user missing values are to be included or excluded in the analysis. The SUMMARY subcommand determines the type of summary analysis to be performed. Currently there is only one type: SUMMARY=TOTAL, which displays per-item analysis tested against the totals.
15.16 ROC
ROC var list BY state var (state value ) /PLOT = { CURVE [(REFERENCE)], NONE } /PRINT = [ SE ] [ COORDINATES ] /CRITERIA = [ CUTOFF({INCLUDE,EXCLUDE}) ] [ TESTPOS ({LARGE,SMALL}) ] [ CI (confidence ) ] [ DISTRIBUTION ({FREE, NEGEXPO }) ] /MISSING={EXCLUDE,INCLUDE}
The ROC command is used to plot the receiver operating characteristic curve of a dataset, and to estimate the area under the curve. This is useful for analysing the efficacy of a variable as a predictor of a state of nature. The mandatory var list is the list of predictor variables. The variable state var is the variable whose values represent the actual states, and state value is the value of this variable which represents the positive state. The optional subcommand PLOT is used to determine if and how the ROC curve is drawn. The keyword CURVE means that the ROC curve should be drawn, and the optional keyword REFERENCE, which should be enclosed in parentheses, says that the diagonal reference line should be drawn. If the keyword NONE is given, then no ROC curve is drawn. By default, the curve is drawn with no reference line. The optional subcommand PRINT determines which additional tables should be printed. Two additional tables are available. The SE keyword says that standard error of the area under the curve should be printed as well as the area itself. In addition, a p-value under the
147
null hypothesis that the area under the curve equals 0.5 will be printed. The COORDINATES keyword says that a table of coordinates of the ROC curve should be printed. The CRITERIA subcommand has four optional parameters: The TESTPOS parameter may be LARGE or SMALL. LARGE is the default, and says that larger values in the predictor variables are to be considered positive. SMALL indicates that smaller values should be considered positive. The CI parameter specifies the confidence interval that should be printed. It has no effect if the SE keyword in the PRINT subcommand has not been given. The DISTRIBUTION parameter determines the method to be used when estimating the area under the curve. There are two possibilities, viz : FREE and NEGEXPO. The FREE method uses a non-parametric estimate, and the NEGEXPO method a bi-negative exponential distribution estimate. The NEGEXPO method should only be used when the number of positive actual states is equal to the number of negative actual states. The default is FREE. The CUTOFF parameter is for compatibility and is ignored. The MISSING subcommand determines whether user missing values are to be included or excluded in the analysis. The default behaviour is to exclude them. Cases are excluded on a listwise basis; if any of the variables in var list or if the variable state var is missing, then the entire case will be excluded.
148
16 Utilities
Commands that dont fit any other category are placed here. Most of these commands are not affected by commands like IF and LOOP: they take effect only once, unconditionally, at the time that they are encountered in the input.
16.2 CACHE
CACHE. This command is accepted, for compatibility, but it has no effect.
16.3 CD
CD new directory . CD changes the current directory. The new directory will become that specified by the command.
16.4 COMMENT
Two possibles syntaxes: COMMENT comment text . . . . *comment text . . . . COMMENT is ignored. It is used to provide information to the author and other readers of the pspp syntax file. COMMENT can extend over any number of lines. Dont forget to terminate it with a dot or a blank line.
16.5 DOCUMENT
DOCUMENT documentary text. DOCUMENT adds one or more lines of descriptive commentary to the active dataset. Documents added in this way are saved to system files. They can be viewed using SYSFILE INFO or DISPLAY DOCUMENTS. They can be removed from the active dataset with DROP DOCUMENTS. Specify the documentary text following the DOCUMENT keyword. It is interpreted literally any quotes or other punctuation marks will be included in the file. You can extend
149
the documentary text over as many lines as necessary. Lines are truncated at 80 bytes. Dont forget to terminate the command with a dot or a blank line. See Section 16.1 [ADD DOCUMENT], page 148.
16.9 ECHO
ECHO arbitrary text . Use ECHO to write arbitrary text to the output stream. The text should be enclosed in quotation marks following the normal rules for string tokens (see Section 6.1 [Tokens], page 26).
16.10 ERASE
ERASE FILE file name. ERASE FILE deletes a file from the local filesystem. file name must be quoted. This command cannot be used if the SAFER (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152) setting is active.
16.11 EXECUTE
EXECUTE. EXECUTE causes the active dataset to be read and all pending transformations to be executed.
150
16.13 FINISH
FINISH. FINISH terminates the current pspp session and returns control to the operating system.
16.14 HOST
HOST. HOST COMMAND=[command ...]. HOST suspends the current pspp session and temporarily returns control to the operating system. This command cannot be used if the SAFER (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152) setting is active. If the COMMAND subcommand is specified, as a sequence of shell commands as quoted strings within square brackets, then pspp executes them together in a single subshell. If no subcommands are specified, then pspp invokes an interactive subshell.
16.15 INCLUDE
INCLUDE [FILE=]file name [ENCODING=encoding ]. INCLUDE causes the pspp command processor to read an additional command file as if it were included bodily in the current command file. If errors are encountered in the included file, then command processing will stop and no more commands will be processed. Include files may be nested to any depth, up to the limit of available memory. The INSERT command (see Section 16.16 [INSERT], page 150) is a more flexible alternative to INCLUDE. An INCLUDE command acts the same as INSERT with ERROR=STOP CD=NO SYNTAX=BATCH specified. The optional ENCODING subcommand has the same meaning as with INSERT.
16.16 INSERT
INSERT [FILE=]file name [CD={NO,YES}] [ERROR={CONTINUE,STOP}] [SYNTAX={BATCH,INTERACTIVE}] [ENCODING={LOCALE, charset name }]. INSERT is similar to INCLUDE (see Section 16.15 [INCLUDE], page 150) but somewhat more flexible. It causes the command processor to read a file as if it were embedded in the current command file.
151
If CD=YES is specified, then before including the file, the current directory will be changed to the directory of the included file. The default setting is CD=NO. Note that this directory will remain current until it is changed explicitly (with the CD command, or a subsequent INSERT command with the CD=YES option). It will not revert to its original setting even after the included file is finished processing. If ERROR=STOP is specified, errors encountered in the inserted file will cause processing to immediately cease. Otherwise processing will continue at the next command. The default setting is ERROR=CONTINUE. If SYNTAX=INTERACTIVE is specified then the syntax contained in the included file must conform to interactive syntax conventions. See Section 6.3 [Syntax Variants], page 28. The default setting is SYNTAX=BATCH. ENCODING optionally specifies the character set used by the included file. Its argument, which is not case-sensitive, must be in one of the following forms: LOCALE The encoding used by the system locale, or as overridden by the SET command (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152). On GNU/Linux and other Unix-like systems, environment variables, e.g. LANG or LC_ALL, determine the system locale.
charset name One of the character set names listed by IANA at http://www.iana.org/assignments/characterSome examples are ASCII (United States), ISO-8859-1 (western Europe), EUC-JP (Japan), and windows-1252 (Windows). Not all systems support all character sets. Auto,encoding Automatically detects whether a syntax file is encoded in an Unicode encoding such as UTF-8, UTF-16, or UTF-32. If it is not, then pspp generally assumes that the file is encoded in encoding (an IANA character set name). However, if encoding is UTF-8, and the syntax file is not valid UTF-8, pspp instead assumes that the file is encoded in windows-1252. For best results, encoding should be an ASCII-compatible encoding (the most common locale encodings are all ASCII-compatible), because encodings that are not ASCII compatible cannot be automatically distinguished from UTF-8. Auto Auto,Locale Automatic detection, as above, with the default encoding taken from the system locale or the setting on SET LOCALE. When ENCODING is not specified, the default is taken from the --syntax-encoding command option, if it was specified, and otherwise it is Auto.
16.17 PERMISSIONS
PERMISSIONS FILE=file name /PERMISSIONS = {READONLY,WRITEABLE}. PERMISSIONS changes the permissions of a file. There is one mandatory subcommand which specifies the permissions to which the file should be changed. If you set a files
152
permission to READONLY, then the file will become unwritable either by you or anyone else on the system. If you set the permission to WRITEABLE, then the file will become writeable by you; the permissions afforded to others will be unchanged. This command cannot be used if the SAFER (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152) setting is active.
16.19 SET
SET (data input) /BLANKS={SYSMIS,.,number} /DECIMAL={DOT,COMMA} /FORMAT=fmt spec /EPOCH={AUTOMATIC,year } /RIB={NATIVE,MSBFIRST,LSBFIRST,VAX} /RRB={NATIVE,ISL,ISB,IDL,IDB,VF,VD,VG,ZS,ZL} (interaction) /MXERRS=max errs /MXWARNS=max warnings /WORKSPACE=workspace size (syntax execution) /LOCALE=locale /MEXPAND={ON,OFF} /MITERATE=max iterations /MNEST=max nest /MPRINT={ON,OFF} /MXLOOPS=max loops /SEED={RANDOM,seed value } /UNDEFINED={WARN,NOWARN} (data output) /CC{A,B,C,D,E}={npre,pre,suf,nsuf ,npre.pre.suf.nsuf } /DECIMAL={DOT,COMMA} /FORMAT=fmt spec /WIB={NATIVE,MSBFIRST,LSBFIRST,VAX} /WRB={NATIVE,ISL,ISB,IDL,IDB,VF,VD,VG,ZS,ZL}
153
(output routing) /ERRORS={ON,OFF,TERMINAL,LISTING,BOTH,NONE} /MESSAGES={ON,OFF,TERMINAL,LISTING,BOTH,NONE} /PRINTBACK={ON,OFF,TERMINAL,LISTING,BOTH,NONE} /RESULTS={ON,OFF,TERMINAL,LISTING,BOTH,NONE} (output driver options) /HEADERS={NO,YES,BLANK} /LENGTH={NONE,n lines } /MORE={ON,OFF} /WIDTH={NARROW,WIDTH,n characters } /TNUMBERS={VALUES,LABELS,BOTH} /TVARS={NAMES,LABELS,BOTH} (logging) /JOURNAL={ON,OFF} [file name ] (system files) /COMPRESSION={ON,OFF} /SCOMPRESSION={ON,OFF} (miscellaneous) /SAFER=ON /LOCALE=string
(obsolete settings accepted for compatibility, but ignored) /BOXSTRING={xxx ,xxxxxxxxxxx } /CASE={UPPER,UPLOW} /CPI=cpi value /HIGHRES={ON,OFF} /HISTOGRAM=c /LOWRES={AUTO,ON,OFF} /LPI=lpi value /MENUS={STANDARD,EXTENDED} /MXMEMORY=max memory /SCRIPTTAB=c /TB1={xxx ,xxxxxxxxxxx } /TBFONTS=string /XSORT={YES,NO} SET allows the user to adjust several parameters relating to pspps execution. Since there are many subcommands to this command, its subcommands will be examined in groups. For subcommands that take boolean values, ON and YES are synonymous, as are OFF and NO, when used as subcommand values.
154
The data input subcommands affect the way that data is read from data files. The data input subcommands are BLANKS This is the value assigned to an item data item that is empty or contains only white space. An argument of SYSMIS or . will cause the system-missing value to be assigned to null items. This is the default. Any real value may be assigned. This value may be set to DOT or COMMA. Setting it to DOT causes the decimal point character to be . and the grouping character to be ,. Setting it to COMMA causes the decimal point character to be , and the grouping character to be .. The default value is determined from the system locale. FORMAT Allows the default numeric input/output format to be specified. The default is F8.2. See Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32. EPOCH Specifies the range of years used when a 2-digit year is read from a data file or used in a date construction expression (see Section 7.7.8.4 [Date Construction], page 52). If a 4-digit year is specified for the epoch, then 2-digit years are interpreted starting from that year, known as the epoch. If AUTOMATIC (the default) is specified, then the epoch begins 69 years before the current date. pspp extension to set the byte ordering (endianness) used for reading data in IB or PIB format (see Section 6.7.4.4 [Binary and Hexadecimal Numeric Formats], page 37). In MSBFIRST ordering, the most-significant byte appears at the left end of a IB or PIB field. In LSBFIRST ordering, the least-significant byte appears at the left end. VAX ordering is like MSBFIRST, except that each pair of bytes is in reverse order. NATIVE, the default, is equivalent to MSBFIRST or LSBFIRST depending on the native format of the machine running pspp. RRB pspp extension to set the floating-point format used for reading data in RB format (see Section 6.7.4.4 [Binary and Hexadecimal Numeric Formats], page 37). The possibilities are: NATIVE ISL ISB IDL IDB VF The native format of the machine running pspp. Equivalent to either IDL or IDB. 32-bit IEEE 754 single-precision floating point, in little-endian byte order. 32-bit IEEE 754 single-precision floating point, in big-endian byte order. 64-bit IEEE 754 double-precision floating point, in little-endian byte order. 64-bit IEEE 754 double-precision floating point, in big-endian byte order. 32-bit VAX F format, in VAX-endian byte order.
DECIMAL
RIB
155
VD VG ZS ZL
64-bit VAX D format, in VAX-endian byte order. 64-bit VAX G format, in VAX-endian byte order. 32-bit IBM Z architecture short format hexadecimal floating point, in big-endian byte order. 64-bit IBM Z architecture long format hexadecimal floating point, in big-endian byte order. Z architecture also supports IEEE 754 floating point. The ZS and ZL formats are only for use with very old input files.
The default is NATIVE. Interaction subcommands affect the way that pspp interacts with an online user. The interaction subcommands are MXERRS The maximum number of errors before pspp halts processing of the current command file. The default is 50. MXWARNS The maximum number of warnings + errors before pspp halts processing the current command file. The special value of zero means that all warning situations should be ignored. No warnings will be issued, except a single initial warning advising the user that warnings will not be given. The default value is 100. Syntax execution subcommands control the way that pspp commands execute. The syntax execution subcommands are LOCALE Overrides the system locale for the purpose of reading and writing syntax and data files. The argument should be a locale name in the general form language _country.encoding , where language and country are 2-character language and country abbreviations, respectively, and encoding is an IANA character set name. Example locales are en_US.UTF-8 (UTF-8 encoded English as spoken in the United States) and ja_JP.EUC-JP (EUC-JP encoded Japanese as spoken in Japan).
MEXPAND MITERATE MNEST MPRINT Currently not used. MXLOOPS The maximum number of iterations for an uncontrolled loop (see Section 14.4 [LOOP], page 121). The default max loops is 40. SEED The initial pseudo-random number seed. Set to a real number or to RANDOM, which will obtain an initial seed from the current time of day.
156
WORKSPACE The maximum amount of memory that pspp will use to store data being processed. If memory in excess of the workspace size is required, then pspp will start to use temporary files to store the data. Setting a higher value will, in general, mean procedures will run faster, but may cause other applications to run slower. On platforms without virtual memory management, setting a very large workspace may cause pspp to abort. Data output subcommands affect the format of output data. These subcommands are CCA CCB CCC CCD CCE Set up custom currency formats. See Section 6.7.4.2 [Custom Currency Formats], page 35, for details. DECIMAL The default DOT setting causes the decimal point character to be .. A setting of COMMA causes the decimal point character to be ,. FORMAT Allows the default numeric input/output format to be specified. The default is F8.2. See Section 6.7.4 [Input and Output Formats], page 32. WIB pspp extension to set the byte ordering (endianness) used for writing data in IB or PIB format (see Section 6.7.4.4 [Binary and Hexadecimal Numeric Formats], page 37). In MSBFIRST ordering, the most-significant byte appears at the left end of a IB or PIB field. In LSBFIRST ordering, the least-significant byte appears at the left end. VAX ordering is like MSBFIRST, except that each pair of bytes is in reverse order. NATIVE, the default, is equivalent to MSBFIRST or LSBFIRST depending on the native format of the machine running pspp. WRB pspp extension to set the floating-point format used for writing data in RB format (see Section 6.7.4.4 [Binary and Hexadecimal Numeric Formats], page 37). The choices are the same as SET RIB. The default is NATIVE. In the pspp text-based interface, the output routing subcommands affect where output is sent. The following values are allowed for each of these subcommands: OFF NONE Discard this kind of output.
TERMINAL Write this output to the terminal, but not to listing files and other output devices. LISTING Write this output to listing files and other output devices, but not to the terminal.
157
ON BOTH ERRORS
Write this type of output to all output devices. Applies to error and warning messages. The default is BOTH.
These output routing subcommands are: MESSAGES Applies to notes. The default is BOTH. PRINTBACK Determines whether the syntax used for input is printed back as part of the output. The default is NONE. RESULTS Applies to everything not in one of the above categories, such as the results of statistical procedures. The default is BOTH. These subcommands have no effect on output in the pspp GUI environment. Output driver option subcommands affect output drivers settings. These subcommands are HEADERS LENGTH MORE WIDTH TNUMBERS The TNUMBERS option sets the way in which values are displayed in output tables. The valid settings are VALUES, LABELS and BOTH. If TNUMBERS is set to VALUES, then all values are displayed with their literal value (which for a numeric value is a number and for a string value an alphanumeric string). If TNUMBERS is set to LABELS, then values are displayed using their assigned labels if any. (See Section 11.12 [VALUE LABELS], page 102.) If the a value has no label, then it will be displayed using its literal value. If TNUMBERS is set to BOTH, then values will be displayed with both their label (if any) and their literal value in parentheses. TVARS The TVARS option sets the way in which variables are displayed in output tables. The valid settings are NAMES, LABELS and BOTH. If TVARS is set to NAMES, then all variables are displayed using their names. If TVARS is set to LABELS, then variables are displayed using their label if one has been set. If no label has been set, then the name will be used. (See Section 11.15 [VARIABLE LABELS], page 104.) If TVARS is set to BOTH, then variables will be displayed with both their label (if any) and their name in parentheses. Logging subcommands affect logging of commands executed to external files. These subcommands are JOURNAL LOG These subcommands, which are synonyms, control the journal. The default is ON, which causes commands entered interactively to be written to the journal file. Commands included from syntax files that are included interactively and error messages printed by pspp are also written to the journal file, prefixed by >. OFF disables use of the journal.
158
The journal is named pspp.jnl by default. A different name may be specified. System file subcommands affect the default format of system files produced by pspp. These subcommands are COMPRESSION Not currently used. SCOMPRESSION Whether system files created by SAVE or XSAVE are compressed by default. The default is ON. Security subcommands affect the operations that commands are allowed to perform. The security subcommands are SAFER Setting this option disables the following operations: The ERASE command. The HOST command. The PERMISSIONS command. Pipes (file names beginning or ending with |). Be aware that this setting does not guarantee safety (commands can still overwrite files, for instance) but it is an improvement. When set, this setting cannot be reset during the same session, for obvious security reasons. LOCALE This item is used to set the default character encoding. The encoding may be specified either as an encoding name or alias (see http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets), or as a locale name. If given as a locale name, only the character encoding of the locale is relevant. System files written by pspp will use this encoding. System files read by pspp, for which the encoding is unknown, will be interpreted using this encoding. The full list of valid encodings and locale names/alias are operating system dependent. The following are all examples of acceptable syntax on common GNU/Linux systems. SET LOCALE=iso-8859-1. SET LOCALE=ru_RU.cp1251. SET LOCALE=japanese. Contrary to the intuition, this command does not affect any aspect of the systems locale.
16.20 SHOW
SHOW [ALL] [BLANKS] [CC] [CCA]
159
[CCB] [CCC] [CCD] [CCE] [COPYING] [DECIMALS] [DIRECTORY] [ENVIRONMENT] [FORMAT] [LENGTH] [MXERRS] [MXLOOPS] [MXWARNS] [N] [SCOMPRESSION] [TEMPDIR] [UNDEFINED] [VERSION] [WARRANTY] [WEIGHT] [WIDTH] SHOW can be used to display the current state of pspps execution parameters. Parameters that can be changed using SET (see Section 16.19 [SET], page 152), can be examined using SHOW using the subcommand with the same name. SHOW supports the following additional subcommands: ALL CC DIRECTORY Shows the current working directory. ENVIRONMENT Shows the operating system details. N TEMPDIR VERSION WARRANTY Show details of the lack of warranty for pspp. COPYING / LICENSE Display the terms of pspps copyright licence (see Chapter 2 [License], page 3). Specifying SHOW without any subcommands is equivalent to SHOW ALL. Reports the number of cases in the active dataset. The reported number is not weighted. If no dataset is defined, then Unknown will be reported. Shows the path of the directory where temporary files will be stored. Shows the version of this installation of pspp. Show all settings. Show all custom currency settings (CCA through CCE).
160
16.21 SUBTITLE
SUBTITLE subtitle string . or SUBTITLE subtitle string. SUBTITLE provides a subtitle to a particular pspp run. This subtitle appears at the top of each output page below the title, if headers are enabled on the output device. Specify a subtitle as a string in quotes. The alternate syntax that did not require quotes is now obsolete. If it is used then the subtitle is converted to all uppercase.
16.22 TITLE
TITLE title string . or TITLE title string. TITLE provides a title to a particular pspp run. This title appears at the top of each output page, if headers are enabled on the output device. Specify a title as a string in quotes. The alternate syntax that did not require quotes is now obsolete. If it is used then the title is converted to all uppercase.
161
17 Not Implemented
This chapter lists parts of the pspp language that are not yet implemented. 2SLS ACF ALSCAL ANACOR ANOVA CASEPLOT Two stage least squares regression Autocorrelation function Multidimensional scaling Correspondence analysis Factorial analysis of variance Plot time series
CASESTOVARS Restructure complex data CATPCA CATREG CCF Categorical principle components analysis Categorical regression Time series cross correlation
CLEAR TRANSFORMATIONS Clears transformations from active dataset CLUSTER CONJOINT Hierarchical clustering Analyse full concept data
CORRESPONDENCE Show correspondence COXREG CREATE Cox proportional hazards regression Create time series data
CSDESCRIPTIVES Complex samples descriptives CSGLM CSLOGISTIC Complex samples logistic regression CSPLAN CSSELECT CSTABULATE Tabulate complex samples CTABLES CURVEFIT DATE DEFINE Display complex samples Fit curve to line plot Create time series data Syntax macros Complex samples design Select complex samples Complex samples GLM
162
DETECTANOMALY Find unusual cases DISCRIMINANT Linear discriminant analysis EDIT obsolete
END FILE TYPE Ends complex data input FILE TYPE Complex data input FIT GENLOG Goodness of Fit Categorical model fitting
GET TRANSLATE Read other file formats GGRAPH GRAPH Custom defined graphs Draw graphs
HILOGLINEAR Hierarchical loglinear models HOMALS IGRAPH INFO Homogeneity analysis Interactive graphs Local Documentation
KEYED DATA LIST Read nonsequential data KM LOGLINEAR General model fitting MANOVA MAPS MATRIX Multivariate analysis of variance Geographical display Matrix processing Kaplan-Meier
MATRIX DATA Matrix data input MCONVERT MIXED Convert covariance/correlation matrices Mixed linear models
MODEL CLOSE Close server connection MODEL HANDLE Define server connection
163
MODEL LIST Show existing models MODEL NAME Specify model label MULTIPLE CORRESPONDENCE Multiple correspondence analysis MULT RESPONSE Multiple response analysis MVA NAIVEBAYES Small sample bayesian prediction NLR NOMREG Non Linear Regression Multinomial logistic regression Missing value analysis
NONPAR CORR Nonparametric correlation NUMBERED OLAP CUBES On-line analytical processing OMS ORTHOPLAN Orthogonal effects design OVERALS PACF Nonlinear canonical correlation Partial autocorrelation Output management
PARTIAL CORR Partial correlation PLANCARDS Conjoint analysis planning PLUM POINT PPLOT PREDICT PREFSCAL PRINCALS PROBIT Estimate ordinal regression models Marker in keyed file Plot time series variables Specify forecast period Multidimensional unfolding PCA by alternating least squares Probit analysis
164
RATIO STATISTICS Descriptives of ratios READ MODEL Read new model RECORD TYPE Defines a type of record within FILE TYPE REFORMAT Read obsolete files
REPEATING DATA Specify multiple cases per input record REPORT RMV SCRIPT SEASON SELECTPRED Select predictor variables SPCHART SPECTRA SUMMARIZE Univariate statistics SURVIVAL TDISPLAY TREE TSAPPLY TSET TSHOW TSMODEL TSPLOT Survival analysis Display active models Create classification tree Apply time series model Set time sequence variables Show time sequence variables Estimate time series model Plot time sequence variables Plot control charts Plot spectral density Pretty print working file Replace missing values Run script file Estimate seasonal factors
165
VARSTOCASES Restructure complex data VERIFY WLS XGRAPH Report time series Weighted least squares regression High resolution charts
166
18 Bugs
Occasionally users encounter problems with pspp. When such problems arise we do our best to fix them, but our limited resources mean that certain issues may remain for some time. If you discover a bug, please first: Try an up to date version of pspp; it may be that the problem has recently been fixed. If the problem persists in the up to date version; check to see if it has already been reported. If the problem exists in a recent version and it has not already been reported, please file a report.
To see a list of reported bugs, visit pspps project webpage at http://savannah.gnu.org/bugs/?group=psp Alternatively, bug reports may be sent by email to bug-gnu-pspp@gnu.org. In your bug report please include: The version of pspp which you are using. The operating system and type of computer on which it is running. A sample of the syntax which causes the problem or, if it is a user interface problem, the sequence of steps required to reproduce it. A description of what you think is wrong: What happened that you didnt expect, and what did you expect to happen? For known bugs in individual language features, see the documentation for that feature.
167
19 Function Index
(
(variable ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
D
DATE.DMY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DATE.MDY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DATE.MOYR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DATE.QYR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DATE.WKYR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DATE.YRDAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DATEDIFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DATESUM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 52 52 52 52 53 54 54
A
ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ACOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ANY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ARCOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ARSIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ARTAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ASIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ATAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 47 48 47 47 47 47 47
E
EXP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
C
CDF.BERNOULLI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.BETA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.BINOMIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.CAUCHY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.CHISQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.EXP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.GAMMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.GEOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.HALFNRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.HYPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.IGAUSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.LAPLACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.LNORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.LOGISTIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.NEGBIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.NORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.PARETO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.POISSON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.RAYLEIGH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.SMOD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.SRANGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.T1G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.T2G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.UNIFORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.VBNOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDF.WEIBULL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CDFNORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CFVAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CONCAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CTIME.DAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CTIME.HOURS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CTIME.MINUTES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CTIME.SECONDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 56 60 57 57 57 57 57 61 58 61 58 58 58 58 61 58 59 61 59 59 59 59 60 60 60 56 60 59 48 49 47 51 52 52 52
I
IDF.BETA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.CAUCHY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.CHISQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.EXP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.GAMMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.HALFNRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.IGAUSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.LAPLACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.LNORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.LOGISTIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.NORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.PARETO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.RAYLEIGH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.SMOD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.SRANGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.T1G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.T2G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.UNIFORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IDF.WEIBULL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 57 57 57 57 57 58 58 58 58 58 58 59 59 59 59 59 60 60 60 60 49
L
LAG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LENGTH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LG10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LNGAMMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LPAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LTRIM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49, 55 49 46 46 46 49 49 50
M
MAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 MEAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
168
48 47 46 46
N
NCDF.BETA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NCDF.CHISQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NCDF.F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NCDF.T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NMISS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NPDF.BETA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NPDF.CHISQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NPDF.F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NPDF.T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NUMBER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NVALID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 57 57 60 47 59 56 57 57 60 50 47
P
PDF.BERNOULLI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.BETA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.BINOMIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.BVNOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.CAUCHY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.CHISQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.EXP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.GAMMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.GEOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.HALFNRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.HYPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.IGAUSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.LANDAU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.LAPLACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.LNORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.LOG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.LOGISTIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.NEGBIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.NORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.NTAIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.PARETO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.POISSON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.RAYLEIGH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.RTAIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.T1G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.T2G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.UNIFORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.WEIBULL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PDF.XPOWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PROBIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 56 60 56 57 57 57 57 57 61 58 61 58 58 58 58 61 58 61 58 59 59 61 59 59 59 60 60 60 60 57 59
RINDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RPAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RTRIM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.BERNOULLI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.BETA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.BINOMIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.CAUCHY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.CHISQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.EXP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.GAMMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.GEOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.HALFNRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.HYPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.IGAUSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.LANDAU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.LAPLACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.LEVY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.LNORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.LOG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.LOGISTIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.LVSKEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.NEGBIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.NORMAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.NTAIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.PARETO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.POISSON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.RAYLEIGH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.RTAIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.UNIFORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.WEIBULL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RV.XPOWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
50 46 50 50 60 56 60 57 57 57 57 57 61 58 61 58 58 58 58 58 61 58 58 61 59 59 59 61 59 59 60 60 60 57
S
SD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SIG.CHISQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SIG.F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SQRT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . STRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SUBSTR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, SUM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SYSMIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 57 57 47 46 50 51 49 47
T
TAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TIME.DAYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TIME.HMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TRUNC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 51 51 46
U R
RANGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 UNIFORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 UPCASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
169
V
VALUE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 VARIANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
X
XDATE.DATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XDATE.HOUR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XDATE.JDAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XDATE.MDAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XDATE.MINUTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 53 53 53 53
53 53 53 53 54 54 54 54
Y
YRMODA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
170
20 Command Index
*
* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
E
ECHO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 END CASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 END DATA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 END FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 ERASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 EXAMINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 EXECUTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 EXPORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
A
ADD DOCUMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 ADD FILES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 ADD VALUE LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 AGGREGATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 APPLY DICTIONARY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 AUTORECODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
F
FACTOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 FILE HANDLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 FILE LABEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 FILTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 FINISH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 FLIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 FORMATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 FREQUENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 FRIEDMAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
B
BEGIN DATA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 BINOMIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 BREAK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
C
CACHE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHISQUARE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cochran . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COMMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COMPUTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CORRELATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COUNT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CROSSTABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 148 137 137 148 109 128 110 128
G
GET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 80 GET DATA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
H
HOST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
D
DATA LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 DATA LIST FIXED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 DATA LIST FREE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 DATA LIST LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 DATAFILE ATTRIBUTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 DATASET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 DATASET ACTIVATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 DATASET CLOSE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 DATASET COPY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 DATASET DECLARE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 DATASET DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 DATASET NAME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 DELETE VARIABLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 DESCRIPTIVES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 DISPLAY DOCUMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 DISPLAY FILE LABEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 DO IF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 DO REPEAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 DOCUMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 DROP DOCUMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
I
IF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 IMPORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 INCLUDE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 INPUT PROGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 INSERT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
K
K-S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . K-W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . KENDALL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . KOLMOGOROV-SMIRNOV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . KRUSKAL-WALLIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 138 137 138 138
L
LEAVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13, 73 LOGISTIC REGRESSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 LOOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
171
M
M-W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 MANN-WHITNEY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 MATCH FILES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 MCNEMAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 MEANS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 MEDIAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 MISSING VALUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 MODIFY VARS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 MRSETS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
S
SAMPLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 SAVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 87 SAVE TRANSLATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 SELECT IF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 SET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 SHOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 SIGN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 SORT CASES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 SPLIT FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 STRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 SUBTITLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 SYSFILE INFO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
N
N OF CASES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 NEW FILE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 NPAR TESTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 NUMERIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
T
T-TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 140 TEMPORARY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 TITLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
O
ONEWAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
P
PERMISSIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 PRESERVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 PRINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 PRINT EJECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 PRINT FORMATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 PRINT SPACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
U
UPDATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
V
VALUE LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VARIABLE ALIGNMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VARIABLE ATTRIBUTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VARIABLE LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VARIABLE LEVEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VARIABLE WIDTH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VECTOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 104 103 104 104 104 105
Q
QUICK CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
R
RANK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 RECODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 REGRESSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 144 RELIABILITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 RENAME VARIABLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 REPEATING DATA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 REREAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 RESTORE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 ROC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 RUNS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
W
WEIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 WILCOXON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 WRITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 WRITE FORMATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
X
XEXPORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 XSAVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
172
21 Concept Index
.
pspp language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
"
" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
/
/ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
$
$CASENUM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $DATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $JDATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $LENGTH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $SYSMIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $TIME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $WIDTH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 32 32 32 32 32 32
<
< . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 <= . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 <> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
=
= . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
&
& . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
>
> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 >= . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 _ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
(
( . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 ( ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
is defined as . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
)
) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
|
| . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
*
* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
~
~ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 ~= . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
+
+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
A
absolute value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 addition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 analysis of variance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 AND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 ANOVA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 arccosine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 arcsine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 arctangent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Area under curve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 arguments, invalid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 arguments, minimum valid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 arguments, of date construction functions . . . . . . 52
,
pspp, command structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 pspp, invoking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 pspp, language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44, 45
173
arguments, of date extraction functions . . . . . . . . 53 arithmetic mean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 arithmetic operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 attributes of variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
B
Backus-Naur Form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Batch syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 binary formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 binomial test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 bivariate logistic regression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 BNF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Boolean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44, 45 boxplot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 bugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
C
case conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 case-sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 cases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 changing directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 changing file permissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 chi-square . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 chisquare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 chisquare test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 clustering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Cochran Q test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 coefficient of concordance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 coefficient of variation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 comma separated values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 command file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 command syntax, description of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 commands, ordering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 commands, structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 commands, unimplemented . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 concatenation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 conditionals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 consistency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 constructing dates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 constructing times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 control flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 convention, TO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 copyright . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 correlation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 cosine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 covariance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Cronbachs Alpha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 cross-case function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 currency formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 custom attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
data reduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 data, embedding in syntax files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Data, embedding in syntax files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 data, fixed-format, reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 data, reading from a file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 databases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 82 dataset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 date examination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 date formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 date, Julian . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 dates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 dates, concepts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 dates, constructing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 dates, day of the month . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, day of the week . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 dates, day of the year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, day-month-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 dates, in days . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, in hours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, in minutes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, in months . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, in quarters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, in seconds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 dates, in weekdays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 dates, in weeks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 dates, in years . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 dates, mathematical properties of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 dates, month-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 dates, quarter-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 dates, time of day . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 dates, valid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 dates, week-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 dates, year-day . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 day of the month . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 day of the week . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 day of the year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 day-month-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 days . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 53 description of command syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 deviation, standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 dictionary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 division . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 DocBook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
E
embedding data in syntax files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Embedding data in syntax files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 embedding fixed-format data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 encoding, characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 equality, testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 erroneous data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 errors, in data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 examination, of times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Exploratory data analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 exponentiation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
D
data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 data file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 data files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
174
43 44 53 51
F
factor analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 false . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 file definition commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 file handles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 file mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 file, command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 file, data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 file, output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 file, portable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 file, syntax file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 file, system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 fixed-format data, reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 flow of control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Friedman test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 function, cross-case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 functions, miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 functions, missing-value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 functions, statistical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 functions, string . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 functions, time & date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
input program commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 integer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 integers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Interactive syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 intersection, logical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 inverse cosine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 inverse sine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 inverse tangent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 inversion, logical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Inverting data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 invocation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
J
Julian date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
K
K-means clustering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Kendalls W test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 keywords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Kolmogorov-Smirnov test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Kruskal-Wallis test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
L
labels, value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 labels, variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 language, pspp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2, 26 language, command structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 language, lexical analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 language, tokens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 LE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 less than . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 less than or equal to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 lexical analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 licence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 license . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Likert scale . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 linear regression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 144 locale . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 logarithms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 logical intersection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 logical inversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 logical operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 logical union . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 logistic regression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 loops . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 LT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
G
GE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 geometric mean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Gnumeric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Graphic user interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 greater than . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 greater than or equal to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 grouping operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 GT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
H
harmonic mean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 headers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 hexadecimal formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 histogram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125, 126 hours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 hours-minutes-seconds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 HTML . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2, 9 Hypothesis testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
I
identifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . identifiers, reserved . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . inequality, testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 26 45 62
M
Mann-Whitney U test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 mathematical expressions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 mathematics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 mathematics, advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
175
mathematics, applied to times & dates . . . . . . . . . 54 mathematics, miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 maximum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 McNemar test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 mean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 means . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Median test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 membership, of set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 memory, amount used to store cases . . . . . . . . . . 156 minimum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 minimum valid number of arguments . . . . . . . . . . . 48 minutes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 missing values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 31, 47 mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 modulus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 modulus, by 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 month-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 months . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 more . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 multiplication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
P
p-value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 padding strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 pager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 parentheses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44, 46 PDF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2, 7 percentiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125, 127 period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 piechart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 portable file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 postgres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Postscript . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 PostScript . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 precedence, operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 principal axis factoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 principal components analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 print format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 productions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 PSPPIRE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 punctuators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27, 43
N
names, of functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 NE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 negation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 nonparametric tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 nonterminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 normality, testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Normality, testing for . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 NOT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 npplot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 null hypothesis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 numbers, converting from strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 numbers, converting to strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 numeric formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Q
Q, Cochran Q . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 quarter-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 quarters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
R
reading data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 reading data from a file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 reading fixed-format data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 reals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Receiver Operating Characteristic . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 recoding data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 regression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 reliability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 reserved identifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 restricted transformations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 rights, your . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 rounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 runs test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
O
obligations, your . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 observations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 OpenDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 operations, order of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 operator precedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27, 43, 46 operators, arithmetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 operators, grouping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 operators, logical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 OR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 order of commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 order of operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 output file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
S
saving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 scratch variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 screening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 searching strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 seconds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 set membership . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 sign test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 sine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 spreadlevel plot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 spreadsheet files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 spreadsheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 square roots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
176
standard deviation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 start symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 string . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 string formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 string functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 strings, case of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49, 51 strings, concatenation of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 strings, converting from numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 strings, converting to numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 strings, finding length of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 strings, padding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49, 50 strings, searching backwards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 strings, taking substrings of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 strings, trimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49, 50 substrings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 subtraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 sum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 SVG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 symbol, start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 syntax file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 SYSMIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 system file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 system files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 system variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 system-missing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
TO convention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 tokens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 transformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 transformations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28, 106 trigonometry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 true . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 truncation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 type of variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
U
U, Mann-Whitney U . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 unimplemented commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 union, logical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 utility commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
V
value label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . value labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . values, Boolean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . values, missing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 31, values, system-missing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . var-list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . var-name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variable labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variable names, ending with period . . . . . . . . . . . . variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variables, attributes of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variables, system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variables, type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variables, width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . variation, coefficient of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 31 44 47 45 43 43 30 31 30 13 30 32 31 31 49 48
T
T-test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 tangent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 terminals and nonterminals, differences . . . . . . . . 43 testing for equality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 testing for inequality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 text files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 time examination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 time formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 time, concepts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 time, in days . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 53 time, in hours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 time, in hours-minutes-seconds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 time, in minutes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 time, in seconds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 53 time, instants of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 time, intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 time, lengths of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 time, mathematical properties of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 times, constructing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 times, in days . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 tnumbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
W
week . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 week-year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 weekday . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 white space, trimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49, 50 width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 width of variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 wilcoxon matched pairs signed ranks test . . . . . 140 workspace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 write format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Y
year-day . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 years . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 your rights and obligations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
177
178
under this License. If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none. The Cover Texts are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words. A Transparent copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the document straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not Transparent is called Opaque. Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ascii without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTEX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only. The Title Page means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in formats which do not have any title page as such, Title Page means the text near the most prominent appearance of the works title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text. The publisher means any person or entity that distributes copies of the Document to the public. A section Entitled XYZ means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as Acknowledgements, Dedications, Endorsements, or History.) To Preserve the Title of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a section Entitled XYZ according to this definition. The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this License. 2. VERBATIM COPYING
179
You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3. You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display copies. 3. COPYING IN QUANTITY If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the Documents license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects. If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent pages. If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general network-using public has access to download using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public. It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document. 4. MODIFICATIONS You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version: A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions (which should, if there were any,
180
be listed in the History section of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if the original publisher of that version gives permission. B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you from this requirement. C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher. D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document. E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright notices. F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below. G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Documents license notice. H. Include an unaltered copy of this License. I. Preserve the section Entitled History, Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If there is no section Entitled History in the Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the previous sentence. J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in the Document for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the History section. You may omit a network location for a work that was published at least four years before the Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers to gives permission. K. For any section Entitled Acknowledgements or Dedications, Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein. L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles. M. Delete any section Entitled Endorsements. Such a section may not be included in the Modified Version. N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled Endorsements or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section. O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers. If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their
181
titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Versions license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other section titles. You may add a section Entitled Endorsements, provided it contains nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various partiesfor example, statements of peer review or that the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard. You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added the old one. The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version. 5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers. The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but different contents, make the title of each such section unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work. In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled History in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled History; likewise combine any sections Entitled Acknowledgements, and any sections Entitled Dedications. You must delete all sections Entitled Endorsements. 6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects. You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
182
7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an aggregate if the copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights of the compilations users beyond what the individual works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves derivative works of the Document. If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of the entire aggregate, the Documents Cover Texts may be placed on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole aggregate. 8. TRANSLATION Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special permission from their copyright holders, but you may include translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of this License, and all the license notices in the Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include the original English version of this License and the original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation and the original version of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will prevail. If a section in the Document is Entitled Acknowledgements, Dedications, or History, the requirement (section 4) to Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual title. 9. TERMINATION You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice. Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the same material does not give you any rights to use it.
183
10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/. Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this License or any later version applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of this License can be used, that proxys public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Document. 11. RELICENSING Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site (or MMC Site) means any World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. A Massive Multiauthor Collaboration (or MMC) contained in the site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC site. CC-BY-SA means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco, California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license published by that same organization. Incorporate means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or in part, as part of another Document. An MMC is eligible for relicensing if it is licensed under this License, and if all works that were first published under this License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior to November 1, 2008. The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing.
184
If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the with. . . Texts. line with this:
with the Invariant Sections being list their titles, with the Front-Cover Texts being list, and with the Back-Cover Texts being list.
If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the situation. If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit their use in free software.